doc: annotate configuration commands
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @section Interface Drivers
2371
2372 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2373 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2374 available at run time.
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2377 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2378 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2379 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2380
2381 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2382 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2383 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2384 @end deffn
2385
2386 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2387 Displays status of RTCK option.
2388 Optionally sets that option first.
2389 @end deffn
2390 @end deffn
2391
2392 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2393 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2394 This has one driver-specific command:
2395
2396 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2397 Logs some status
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2402 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2403 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2404 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2405 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2406 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2410 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2411 or v2 (USB bulk).
2412
2413 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2414 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2415 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2416 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2417 @example
2418 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2419 @end example
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2423 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2424 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2428 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2429
2430 @itemize @minus
2431 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2432 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2433 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2434 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2435 @end itemize
2436 @end deffn
2437
2438 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2439 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2440 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2441 interface string or for user class interface.
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2445 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2446 @end deffn
2447 @end deffn
2448
2449 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2450 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2454 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2458 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2459 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2460
2461 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2462 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2463
2464 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2465 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2466
2467 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2468 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2469 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2470 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2471 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2472 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2473
2474 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2475 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2476 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2477 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2478 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2479
2480 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2481 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2482 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2483 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2484
2485 @itemize @minus
2486 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2487 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2488 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2489 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2490 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2491 switching data and direction as necessary
2492 @end itemize
2493
2494 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2495 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2496
2497 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2498 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2499 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2500 @example
2501 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2502 @end example
2503 @end deffn
2504
2505 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2506 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2507 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2508 during device selection.
2509 @end deffn
2510
2511 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2512 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2513 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2514 is connected to the host.
2515 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2516 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2517 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2521 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2522 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2523
2524 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2525 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2526 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2527 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2528 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2529
2530 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2531 @end deffn
2532
2533 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2534 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2535 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2536 @end deffn
2537
2538 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2539 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2540 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2541 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2542 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2543 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2544 and initially asserted reset signals.
2545 @end deffn
2546
2547 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2548 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2549 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2550 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2551 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2552 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2553 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2554 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2555 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2556 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2557 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2558
2559 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2560 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2561 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2562 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2563 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2564 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2565
2566 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2567 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2568 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2569 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2570 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2571 are always driven by the FTDI.
2572
2573 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2574 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2575 @var{name}.
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2579 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2580 @itemize @minus
2581 @item @option{0}, drive low
2582 @item @option{1}, drive high
2583 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2584 @end itemize
2585 @end deffn
2586
2587 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2588 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2592 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2593
2594 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2595 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2596 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2597 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2598 @itemize @minus
2599 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2600 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2601 @end itemize
2602 @end deffn
2603
2604 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2605 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2606
2607 @end deffn
2608
2609 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2610 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2611 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2612 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2613
2614 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2615 @itemize @minus
2616 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2617 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2618 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2619 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2620 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2621 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2622 @end itemize
2623
2624 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2625 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2626 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2627 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2628 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2629 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2630 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2631 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2632
2633 FT232R
2634 @itemize @minus
2635 @item bit 7 - RI
2636 @item bit 6 - DCD
2637 @item bit 5 - DSR
2638 @item bit 4 - DTR
2639 @item bit 3 - CTS
2640 @item bit 2 - RTS
2641 @item bit 1 - RXD
2642 @item bit 0 - TXD
2643 @end itemize
2644
2645 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2646 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2649 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2650 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2651 @end deffn
2652
2653 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2654 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2655 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2656 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2660 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2661 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2662 @end deffn
2663
2664 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2665 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2666 @end deffn
2667
2668 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2669 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2670 @end deffn
2671
2672 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2673 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2677 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2678 @end deffn
2679
2680 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2681 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2682 @end deffn
2683
2684 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2685 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2689 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2690 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2691 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2692 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2693 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2694 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2695 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2696 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2697 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2698 @end deffn
2699
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2703 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2704 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2705 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2706
2707 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2708 processors which are being simulated.
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2711 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2712 sockets instead of TCP.
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2716 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2717 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2718 @end deffn
2719
2720 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2721 something like:
2722
2723 @example
2724 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2725 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2726 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2727 @end example
2728
2729 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2730 named mysocket:
2731
2732 @example
2733 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2734 remote_bitbang_port 0
2735 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2736 @end example
2737 @end deffn
2738
2739 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2740 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2741 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2742 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2743
2744 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2745 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2746 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2747 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2748 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2749 @end deffn
2750
2751 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2752 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2753 default values are used.
2754 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2755 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2756 @example
2757 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2758 @end example
2759 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2760 @example
2761 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2762 @end example
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2766 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2767 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2768 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2769 target board.
2770
2771 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2772 @example
2773 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2774 reset_config srst_only
2775 @end example
2776 @end deffn
2777
2778 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2779 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2780 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2781 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2782 @end deffn
2783
2784 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2785 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2786 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2787 @end deffn
2788
2789 @end deffn
2790
2791 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2792 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2793 This has one driver-specific command:
2794
2795 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2796 Display either the address of the I/O port
2797 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2798 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2799 This is a write-once setting.
2800 @end deffn
2801 @end deffn
2802
2803 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2804 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2805 transports.
2806
2807 @quotation Compatibility Note
2808 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2809 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2810 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2811 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2812 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2813 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2814 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2815 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2816 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2817 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2818 @end quotation
2819
2820 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2821 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2822 states.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2825 Display free device internal memory.
2826 @end deffn
2827 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2828 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2829 command version.
2830 @end deffn
2831 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2832 Display the device configuration.
2833 @end deffn
2834 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2835 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2836 power state.
2837 @end deffn
2838 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2839 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2840 @end deffn
2841 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2842 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2843 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2844 IP configuration.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2847 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2848 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2849 @end deffn
2850 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2851 Reset the current configuration.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2854 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2857 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2858 pairs.
2859
2860 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2861 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2862 @example
2863 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2864 @end example
2865 @end deffn
2866 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2867 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2868 pairs.
2869
2870 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2871 @example
2872 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2873 77a90000
2874 @end example
2875 @end deffn
2876 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2877 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2878 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2879 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2880 the serial number instead, if possible.
2881
2882 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2883 @end deffn
2884 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2885 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2886 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2887
2888 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2889 @end deffn
2890 @end deffn
2891
2892 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2893 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2894 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2895 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2896 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2897 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2898 configuration script.
2899
2900 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2901 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2902 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2903 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2904 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2905
2906 Known limitations:
2907 @itemize @bullet
2908 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2909 and 2.7 MHz.
2910 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2911 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2912 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2913 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2914 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2915 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2916 communications with the target.
2917 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2918 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2919 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2920 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2921 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2922 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2923 @end itemize
2924
2925 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2926 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2927 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2928 @end deffn
2929
2930 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2931 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2932 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2933 @end deffn
2934
2935 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2936 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2937 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2938 target as a side-effect.
2939 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2940 @end deffn
2941
2942 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2943 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2944 version, and target voltage.
2945 @end deffn
2946 @end deffn
2947
2948 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2949 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2950 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2951 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2952 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2953
2954 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2955 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2956 This is a write-once setting.
2957 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2958
2959 @itemize @minus
2960 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2961 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2962 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2963 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2964 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2965 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2966 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2967 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2968 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2969 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2970 some versions of
2971 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2972 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2973 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2974 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2975 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2976 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2977 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2978 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2979 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2980 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2981 @end itemize
2982 @end deffn
2983
2984 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2985 Display either the address of the I/O port
2986 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2987 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2988 This is a write-once setting.
2989
2990 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2991 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2992 you may encounter a problem.
2993 @end deffn
2994
2995 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2996 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2997 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2998 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2999 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3000 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3001
3002 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3003 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3004 @quotation Tip
3005 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3006 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3007 @example
3008 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3009 > adapter speed 500
3010 @end example
3011 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3012 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3013 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3014 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3015 large set of samples.
3016 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3017 @example
3018 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3019 @end example
3020 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3021 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3022
3023 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3024 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3025 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3026 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3027 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3028 be conservative.
3029 @end quotation
3030 @end deffn
3031
3032 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3033 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3034 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3035 @end deffn
3036
3037 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3038 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3039
3040 @example
3041 adapter driver parport
3042 parport_port 0x278
3043 parport_cable wiggler
3044 @end example
3045 @end deffn
3046
3047 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3048 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3049 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3050 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3051 @end deffn
3052 @end deffn
3053
3054 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3055 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3059 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3060 @end deffn
3061
3062 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3063 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3064
3065 @quotation Note
3066 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3067 which are not currently documented here.
3068 @end quotation
3069 @end deffn
3070
3071 @anchor{hla_interface}
3072 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3073 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3074 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3075 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3076
3077 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3078 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3079 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3080 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3081 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3082 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3083
3084 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3085 Currently Not Supported.
3086 @end deffn
3087
3088 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3089 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3090 @end deffn
3091
3092 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3093 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3097 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3098 @end deffn
3099
3100 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3101 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3102 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3103
3104 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3105 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3106 ST-LINK server software module}.
3107 @end deffn
3108
3109 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3110 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3111 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3112 @end deffn
3113 @end deffn
3114
3115 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3116 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3117 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3118 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3119 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3120
3121 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3122 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3123 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3124 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3125
3126 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3127 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3128
3129 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3130 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3131 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3132
3133 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3134 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3135 ST-LINK server software module}.
3136
3137 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3138 @end deffn
3139
3140 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3141 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3145 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3146 @end deffn
3147 @end deffn
3148
3149 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3150 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3151 @end deffn
3152
3153 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3154 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3155 @end deffn
3156
3157 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3158 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3159 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3160 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3161 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3162
3163 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3164 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3165 XDS110 found will be used.
3166 @end deffn
3167
3168 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3169 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3170 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3171 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3172 @end deffn
3173
3174 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3175 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3176 version).
3177 @end deffn
3178 @end deffn
3179
3180 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3181 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3182 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3183 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3184 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3185
3186 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3187
3188 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3189 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3190
3191 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3192 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3193
3194 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3195
3196 @end deffn
3197 @end deffn
3198
3199 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3200 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3201 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3202
3203 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3204 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3205 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3206 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3207 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3208 configuration on exit.
3209
3210 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3211 pinout.
3212
3213 @end deffn
3214
3215 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3216 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3217 of the one which is most popular.
3218
3219 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3220
3221 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3222 pinout.
3223
3224 @end deffn
3225
3226
3227 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3228 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3229 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3230
3231 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3232 @end deffn
3233
3234
3235 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3236 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3237 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3238
3239 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3240 @end deffn
3241
3242
3243 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3244 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3245 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3246
3247 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3248 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3249 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3250
3251 @itemize @minus
3252 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3253 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3254 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3255 @end itemize
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3259 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3260 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3261 @end deffn
3262 @end deffn
3263
3264
3265 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3266 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3267 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3268 DPI server interface.
3269
3270 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3271 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3272 @end deffn
3273
3274 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3275 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3276 @end deffn
3277 @end deffn
3278
3279
3280 @section Transport Configuration
3281 @cindex Transport
3282 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3283 and the debug adapter you are using,
3284 several transports may be available to
3285 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3286 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3287 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3288 version of OpenOCD.
3289 @end deffn
3290
3291 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3292 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3293
3294 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3295 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3296 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3297 adapter's driver).
3298
3299 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3300 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3301 supported by the debug adapter.
3302
3303 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3304 transport, if any.
3305 @end deffn
3306
3307 @subsection JTAG Transport
3308 @cindex JTAG
3309 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3310 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3311 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3312 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3313 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3314 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3315
3316 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3317 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3318 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3319 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3320 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3321
3322 @subsection SWD Transport
3323 @cindex SWD
3324 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3325 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3326 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3327 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3328 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3329 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3330 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3331
3332 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3333 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3334 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3335 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3336 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3337
3338 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3339 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3340 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3341 expected to change.
3342 @end deffn
3343 @deffn {Command} {swd wcr trn prescale}
3344 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3345 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3346 No parameters: displays current settings.
3347 @end deffn
3348
3349 @subsection SPI Transport
3350 @cindex SPI
3351 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3352 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3353 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3354 solution for flash programming.
3355
3356 @anchor{swimtransport}
3357 @subsection SWIM Transport
3358 @cindex SWIM
3359 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3360 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3361 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3362 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3363
3364 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3365
3366 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3367
3368 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3369 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3370 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3371 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3372 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3373
3374 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3375 @section JTAG Speed
3376 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3377 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3378 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3379 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3380 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3381 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3382 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3383 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3384 power management software that may be active.
3385
3386 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3387 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3388 target event handler.
3389 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3390 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3391 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3392 sets up those clocks).
3393 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3394 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3395 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3396 in the target config file.
3397 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3398 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3399 config file instead.
3400 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3401 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3402 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3403
3404 @example
3405 jtag_rclk 3000
3406 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3407 @end example
3408
3409 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3410 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3411 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3412 may not be the fastest solution.
3413
3414 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3415 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3416 which support adaptive clocking.
3417
3418 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3419 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3420 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3421 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3422 than the speed specified.
3423
3424 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3425 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3426 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3427 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3428
3429 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3430 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3431 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3432 JTAG clocking after setup.
3433 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3434 If the interface device can not
3435 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3436 @end deffn
3437
3438 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3439 @cindex adaptive clocking
3440 @cindex RTCK
3441 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3442 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3443 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3444 @example
3445 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3446 jtag_rclk 3000
3447 @end example
3448 @end defun
3449
3450 @node Reset Configuration
3451 @chapter Reset Configuration
3452 @cindex Reset Configuration
3453
3454 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3455 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3456 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3457 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3458 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3459 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3460 Please see the various board files for examples.
3461
3462 @quotation Note
3463 To maintainers and integrators:
3464 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3465 Normally the board configuration file
3466 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3467 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3468
3469 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3470 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3471 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3472 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3473 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3474 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3475 @end quotation
3476
3477 @section Types of Reset
3478
3479 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3480 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3481 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3482
3483 @itemize @bullet
3484 @item
3485 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3486 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3487 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3488 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3489 @item
3490 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3491 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3492 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3493 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3494 @item
3495 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3496 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3497 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3498 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3499 @item
3500 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3501 several other types of reset.
3502 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3503 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3504 There may be individual module resets.
3505 @end itemize
3506
3507 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3508 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3509 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3510 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3511 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3512 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3513 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3514 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3515 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3516
3517 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3518 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3519
3520 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3521 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3522 common issues are:
3523
3524 @itemize @bullet
3525
3526 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3527 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3528 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3529 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3530 when either of those signals is not connected.
3531 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3532 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3533 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3534 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3535
3536 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3537 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3538 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3539 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3540
3541 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3542 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3543 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3544 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3545 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3546 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3547 hardware debouncing.
3548 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3549 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3550
3551 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3552 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3553 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3554 to use push/pull output drivers.
3555 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3556 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3557 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3558 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3559
3560 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3561 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3562 issues (not limited to errata).
3563 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3564 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3565 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3566 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3567 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3568 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3569 @end itemize
3570
3571 There can also be other issues.
3572 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3573 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3574 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3575 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3576 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3577 Agreement (NDA).
3578
3579 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3580 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3581 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3582
3583 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3584 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3585
3586 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3587
3588 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3589 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3590 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3591 allowing it to be deasserted.
3592 @end deffn
3593
3594 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3595 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3596 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3597 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3598 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3599 @end deffn
3600
3601 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3602 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3603 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3604 allowing it to be deasserted.
3605 @end deffn
3606
3607 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3608 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3609 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3610 @end deffn
3611
3612 @anchor{reset_config}
3613 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3614 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3615 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3616 configuration scripts.
3617
3618 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3619 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3620 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3621 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3622 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3623 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3624 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3625 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3626
3627 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3628 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3629 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3630 -- may be specified at a time.
3631 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3632 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3633 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3634 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3635 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3636
3637 @itemize
3638 @item
3639 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3640 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3641 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3642 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3643 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3644
3645 @quotation Tip
3646 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3647 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3648 @end quotation
3649
3650 @item
3651 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3652 signal implementations.
3653 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3654 indicating everything behaves normally.
3655 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3656 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3657 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3658 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3659 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3660 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3661 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3662
3663 @item
3664 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3665 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3666 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3667 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3668 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3669 while SRST is asserted.
3670 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3671 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3672
3673 @item
3674 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3675 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3676 is required to use this option.
3677 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3678 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3679 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3680 be asserted before any target connection.
3681 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3682 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3683 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3684 @end itemize
3685
3686 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3687 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3688 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3689 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3690 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3691
3692 @itemize
3693 @item
3694 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3695 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3696 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3697 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3698
3699 @item
3700 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3701 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3702 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3703 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3704 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3705 @end itemize
3706 @end deffn
3707
3708 @section Custom Reset Handling
3709 @cindex events
3710
3711 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3712 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3713 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3714 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3715 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3716 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3717
3718 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3719 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3720 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3721 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3722 want to reset everything at once.
3723
3724 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3725 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3726 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3727 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3728 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3729 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3730 needs special attention.
3731
3732 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3733 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3734 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3735 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3736 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3737 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3738 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3739 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3740 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3741
3742 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3743 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3744 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3745 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3746 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3747
3748 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3749 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3750 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3751 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3752 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3753 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3754 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3755 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3756 or potentially some other value.
3757
3758 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3759 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3760 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3761 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3762 (or their associated targets)
3763 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3764
3765 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3766 they return.
3767 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3768 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3769 @end deffn
3770
3771 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3772 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3773 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3774 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3775 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3776 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3777 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3778 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3779 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3780 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3781 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3782 @end deffn
3783
3784 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3785 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3786 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3787 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3788 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3789 @end deffn
3790
3791
3792 @node TAP Declaration
3793 @chapter TAP Declaration
3794 @cindex TAP declaration
3795 @cindex TAP configuration
3796
3797 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3798 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3799
3800 @itemize @bullet
3801 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3802 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3803 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3804 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3805 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3806 start running that code.
3807 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3808 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3809 and missing connections.
3810 @end itemize
3811
3812 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3813 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3814 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3815 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3816 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3817
3818 @section Scan Chains
3819 @cindex scan chain
3820
3821 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3822 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3823 They also need to be added to
3824 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3825 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3826 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3827 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3828 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3829 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3830 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3831 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3832
3833 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3834 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3835 command, presented in the next chapter.
3836 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3837 debugging targets.)
3838 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3839
3840 @verbatim
3841 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3842 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3843 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3844 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3845 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3846 @end verbatim
3847
3848 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3849 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3850 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3851 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3852 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3853 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3854 until they are told to do so.
3855
3856 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3857 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3858 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3859 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3860
3861 @example
3862 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3863 @end example
3864
3865 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3866 by a given chip.
3867 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3868 and so forth.
3869 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3870 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3871 both inside a single chip and between them.
3872 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3873
3874 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3875 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3876 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3877 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3878 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3879 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3880 includes commands something like this:
3881
3882 @example
3883 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3884 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3885 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3886 @end example
3887
3888 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3889 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3890 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3891
3892 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
3893 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3894 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3895 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3896 @example
3897 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3898 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3899 @}
3900 @end example
3901 @end deffn
3902
3903 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
3904 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3905 and their status.
3906 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3907 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3908 but systems with a JTAG router can
3909 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3910 @end deffn
3911
3912 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3913 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3914
3915 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3916 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3917
3918 @section TAP Names
3919 @cindex dotted name
3920
3921 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3922 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3923 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3924 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3925 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3926 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3927 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3928 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3929
3930 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3931 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3932 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3933
3934 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3935
3936 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3937 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3938 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3939
3940 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3941 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3942 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3943 overridable.
3944
3945 @cindex TAP naming convention
3946 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3947 and should follow this convention:
3948
3949 @itemize @bullet
3950 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3951 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3952 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3953 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3954 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3955 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3956 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3957 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3958 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3959 with a single TAP;
3960 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3961 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3962 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3963 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3964 @end itemize
3965
3966 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3967
3968 @itemize @bullet
3969 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3970 @*The length in bits of the
3971 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3972 @end itemize
3973
3974 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3975
3976 @itemize @bullet
3977 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3978 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3979 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3980 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3981 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3982 (the TAP is linked in).
3983 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3984 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3985 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3986 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3987 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3988 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3989 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3990 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3991 values that were found but not included in the list.
3992
3993 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3994 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3995 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3996 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3997 hardware to find these values.
3998 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3999 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4000 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4001 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4002 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4003 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4004 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4005 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4006 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4007 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4008 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4009 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4010 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4011 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4012 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4013 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4014 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4015 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4016 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4017 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4018 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4019 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4020 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4021 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4022 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4023 @end itemize
4024 @end deffn
4025
4026 @section Other TAP commands
4027
4028 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4029 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4030 @end deffn
4031
4032 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4033 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4034 At this writing this TAP attribute
4035 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4036 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4037 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4038 See the next section for information about the available events.
4039
4040 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4041 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4042 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4043 @end deffn
4044
4045 @section TAP Events
4046 @cindex events
4047 @cindex TAP events
4048
4049 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4050 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4051 The other applies to debugger targets,
4052 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4053
4054 The TAP events currently defined are:
4055
4056 @itemize @bullet
4057 @item @b{post-reset}
4058 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4059 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4060 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4061 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4062 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4063
4064 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4065 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4066 of any particular target.
4067 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4068 @item @b{setup}
4069 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4070 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4071 @item @b{tap-disable}
4072 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4073 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4074 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4075 @item @b{tap-enable}
4076 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4077 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4078 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4079 @end itemize
4080
4081 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4082 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4083 contents to be accurate), you might:
4084
4085 @example
4086 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4087 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4088 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4089 @}
4090 @end example
4091
4092
4093 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4094 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4095 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4096 @cindex jrc
4097
4098 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4099 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4100 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4101 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4102 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4103
4104 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4105 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4106 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4107 be visible.
4108 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4109 ignores, such as:
4110
4111 @itemize
4112 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4113 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4114 TAPs receive new instructions.
4115 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4116 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4117 @end itemize
4118
4119 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4120 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4121 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4122 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4123
4124 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4125 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4126
4127 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4128 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4129 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4130 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4131 should define TAP event handlers using
4132 code that looks something like this:
4133
4134 @example
4135 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4136 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4137 @}
4138 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4139 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4140 @}
4141 @end example
4142
4143 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4144
4145 @example
4146 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4147 @end example
4148
4149 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4150 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4151 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4152 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4153
4154 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4155 If necessary, disables the tap
4156 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4157 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4158 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4159 and "0" if it is disabled.
4160 @end deffn
4161
4162 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4163 If necessary, enables the tap
4164 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4165 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4166 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4167 and "0" if it is disabled.
4168 @end deffn
4169
4170 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4171 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4172 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4173 and "0" if it is disabled.
4174
4175 @quotation Note
4176 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4177 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4178 @end quotation
4179 @end deffn
4180
4181 @anchor{autoprobing}
4182 @section Autoprobing
4183 @cindex autoprobe
4184 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4185
4186 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4187 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4188 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4189 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4190
4191 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4192 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4193 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4194 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4195 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4196 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4197 right when they come out of reset).
4198
4199 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4200
4201 @example
4202 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4203 reset_config trst_and_srst
4204 jtag_rclk 8
4205 @end example
4206
4207 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4208 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4209
4210 @enumerate
4211 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4212 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4213 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4214 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4215 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4216 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4217 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4218 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4219 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4220 that is discovered.
4221 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4222 register, it will report it.
4223 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4224 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4225 @end enumerate
4226
4227 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4228 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4229 that's a bit more complex:
4230
4231 @example
4232 clock speed 8 kHz
4233 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4234 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4235 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4236 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4237 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4238 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4239 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4240 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4241 @end example
4242
4243 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4244 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4245 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4246 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4247 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4248 and so forth.
4249
4250 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4251 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4252 @cindex DAP declaration
4253
4254 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4255 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4256 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4257 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4258 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4259
4260 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4261
4262 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4263 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4264 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4265 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4266 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4267
4268 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4269
4270 @itemize @bullet
4271 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4272 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4273 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4274 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4275 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4276 @end itemize
4277 @end deffn
4278
4279 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4280 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4281 for TCL scripting.
4282 @end deffn
4283
4284 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4285 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4286 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4287 @end deffn
4288
4289 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4290 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4291 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4292 initialization, too.
4293 @end deffn
4294
4295 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4296
4297 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4298 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4299 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4300 @end deffn
4301
4302 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4303 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4304 @end deffn
4305
4306 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4307 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4308 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4309 or set a new value @var{value}.
4310 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4311 @end deffn
4312
4313 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4314 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4315 @end deffn
4316
4317 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4318 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4319 value @var{value}.
4320
4321 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4322 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4323 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4324
4325 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4326 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4327 @end deffn
4328
4329 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4330 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4331 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4332 @end deffn
4333
4334 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4335 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4336 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4337 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4338 @end deffn
4339
4340 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4341 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4342
4343 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4344 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4345 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4346 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4347 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4348 for details.
4349
4350 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4351 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4352 the pattern:
4353 @example
4354 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4355 @end example
4356
4357 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4358 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4359 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4360 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4361 @example
4362 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4363 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4364 @end example
4365
4366 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4367 @example
4368 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4369 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4370 @end example
4371
4372 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4373 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4374
4375 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4376 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4377 example with a proper dap name:
4378 @example
4379 xxx.dap apcsw default
4380 @end example
4381 @end deffn
4382
4383 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4384 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4385 Disabled by default
4386 @end deffn
4387
4388
4389 @node CPU Configuration
4390 @chapter CPU Configuration
4391 @cindex GDB target
4392
4393 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4394 You can also access these targets without GDB
4395 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4396 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4397 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4398 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4399
4400 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4401 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4402
4403 @section Target List
4404 @cindex target, current
4405 @cindex target, list
4406
4407 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4408 where each member has a name.
4409 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4410 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4411 (plural!) command.
4412 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4413 look like with more than one:
4414 @verbatim
4415 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4416 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4417 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4418 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4419 @end verbatim
4420
4421 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4422 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4423 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4424 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4425 space seen by that current target.
4426 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4427 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4428 are examples; and there are many more.
4429
4430 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4431
4432 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4433 Returns the name of the current target.
4434 @end deffn
4435
4436 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4437 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4438 @example
4439 foreach t [target names] @{
4440 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4441 @}
4442 @end example
4443 @end deffn
4444
4445 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4446 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4447
4448 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4449 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4450 command names are singular.}
4451
4452 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4453 targets in a user friendly form.
4454
4455 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4456 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4457 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4458 @end deffn
4459
4460 @section Target CPU Types
4461 @cindex target type
4462 @cindex CPU type
4463
4464 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4465 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4466 when calling @command{target create}.
4467 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4468 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4469 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4470 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4471 what core-specific commands may be available
4472 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4473 and more.
4474
4475 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4476 since there's a command to list them.
4477
4478 @anchor{targettypes}
4479 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4480 Lists all supported target types.
4481 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4482
4483 @itemize @bullet
4484 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4485 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4486 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4487 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4488 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4489 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4490 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4491 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4492 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4493 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4494 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4495 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4496 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4497 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4498 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4499 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4500 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4501 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4502 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4503 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4504 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4505 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4506 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4507 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4508 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4509 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4510 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4511 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4512 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4513 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4514 support for new CPUs.
4515 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4516 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}), and a fake ARM core will
4517 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4518 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4519 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4520 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4521 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4522 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4523 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4524 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4525 @itemize @minus
4526 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4527 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4528 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4529 @end itemize
4530 And two debug interfaces cores:
4531 @itemize @minus
4532 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4533 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4534 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4535 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4536 @end itemize
4537 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4538 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4539 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4540 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4541 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4542 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4543 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4544 @end itemize
4545 @end deffn
4546
4547 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4548 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4549 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4550 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4551 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4552 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4553 reflect design generations;
4554 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4555 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4556
4557 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4558 @section Target Configuration
4559
4560 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4561 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4562 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4563 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4564 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4565
4566 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4567 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4568 optional parts.
4569 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4570 command, created as part of target creation.
4571
4572 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4573 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4574 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4575 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4576 to be much more board-specific.
4577 The key steps you use might look something like this
4578
4579 @example
4580 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4581 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4582 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4583 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4584 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4585 @end example
4586
4587 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4588 on-chip SRAM.
4589 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4590 writes to target memory;
4591 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4592 GDB memory checksumming;
4593 and more.
4594
4595 @quotation Warning
4596 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4597 inaccessible when application code
4598 (such as an operating system)
4599 enables or disables the MMU.
4600 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4601 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4602 easy access to other addresses needed.
4603 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4604 @end quotation
4605
4606 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4607 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4608 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4609 controllers.
4610 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4611 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4612 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4613
4614 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4615 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4616 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4617 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4618 purposes including additional configuration.
4619
4620 @itemize @bullet
4621 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4622 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4623 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4624 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4625
4626 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4627 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4628 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4629 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4630 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4631 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4632 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4633
4634 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4635 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4636 @end itemize
4637 @end deffn
4638
4639 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4640 The options accepted by this command may also be
4641 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4642 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4643 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4644
4645 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4646 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4647 and changing its endianness.
4648
4649 @itemize @bullet
4650
4651 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4652 used to access this target.
4653
4654 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4655 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4656 create and manage DAP instances.
4657
4658 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4659 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4660
4661 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4662 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4663 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4664 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4665 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4666 same event name assigns only one handler.
4667
4668 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4669 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4670
4671 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4672 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4673 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4674 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4675 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4676 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4677 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4678
4679 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4680 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4681 or virtual address is being used.
4682
4683 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4684 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4685
4686 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4687 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4688 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4689 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4690 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4691
4692 @anchor{rtostype}
4693 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4694 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4695 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4696 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4697 @option{RIOT}
4698 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4699
4700 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4701 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4702 access the target for debugging.
4703
4704 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4705 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4706 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4707 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4708
4709 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4710 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4711 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4712 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4713 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4714
4715 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4716 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4717 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4718 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4719 command @command{gdb_port}.
4720 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4721
4722 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4723 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4724 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4725 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4726 @end itemize
4727 @end deffn
4728
4729 @section Other $target_name Commands
4730 @cindex object command
4731
4732 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4733 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4734
4735 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4736 Once a button is created a button
4737 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4738 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4739 configure it like this:
4740
4741 @example
4742 # Create
4743 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4744 # Modify
4745 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4746 # Query
4747 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4748 # Report
4749 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4750 @end example
4751
4752 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4753 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4754
4755 @example
4756 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4757 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4758 @end example
4759
4760 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4761
4762 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4763 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4764 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4765 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4766 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4767 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4768 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4769 They are not otherwise documented here.
4770 @end deffn
4771
4772 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4773 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4774 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4775 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4776 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4777 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4778 the target side uses raw memory.
4779
4780 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4781 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4782 The script orientation comes from working with data
4783 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4784 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4785 and neither store nor return those values.
4786
4787 @itemize
4788 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4789 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4790 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4791 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4792 @end itemize
4793 @end deffn
4794
4795 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4796 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4797 @command{$target_name configure}
4798 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4799 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4800 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4801 There are a few special cases:
4802
4803 @itemize @bullet
4804 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4805 event named @var{event_name}.
4806 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4807 two parameters.
4808 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4809 This is a special case because this is set using
4810 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4811 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4812 @end itemize
4813
4814 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4815 all the targets you might use something like this:
4816
4817 @example
4818 foreach name [target names] @{
4819 set y [$name cget -endian]
4820 set z [$name cget -type]
4821 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4822 $x $name $y $z]
4823 @}
4824 @end example
4825 @end deffn
4826
4827 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4828 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4829 Displays the current target state:
4830 @code{debug-running},
4831 @code{halted},
4832 @code{reset},
4833 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4834 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4835 @end deffn
4836
4837 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4838 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4839 currently associated with this target.
4840 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4841 @end deffn
4842
4843 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4844 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4845 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4846 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4847 @end deffn
4848
4849 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4850 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4851 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4852 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4853 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4854 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4855 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4856 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4857 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4858 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4859 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4860 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4861 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4862 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4863 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4864 @end deffn
4865
4866 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4867 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4868 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4869 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4870 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4871 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4872 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4873 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4874 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4875 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4876 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4877 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4878 @end deffn
4879
4880 @anchor{targetevents}
4881 @section Target Events
4882 @cindex target events
4883 @cindex events
4884 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4885 For example:
4886 @itemize @bullet
4887 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4888 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4889 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4890 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4891 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4892 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4893 to set up system clocks or
4894 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4895 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4896 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4897 @end itemize
4898
4899 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4900 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4901 @command{target create ... -event}.
4902
4903 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4904 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4905 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4906
4907 @example
4908 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4909 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4910 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4911 @}
4912 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4913 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4914 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4915 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4916 @}
4917 @end example
4918
4919 The following target events are defined:
4920
4921 @itemize @bullet
4922 @item @b{debug-halted}
4923 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4924 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4925 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4926 @item @b{early-halted}
4927 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4928 @item @b{examine-start}
4929 @* Before target examine is called.
4930 @item @b{examine-end}
4931 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4932 @item @b{examine-fail}
4933 @* After target examine fails.
4934 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4935 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4936 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4937 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4938 connect GDB to running target.
4939 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4940 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4941 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4942 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4943 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4944 is in RAM or read only memory.
4945 Default is @code{halt}
4946 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4947 @* When GDB disconnects
4948 @item @b{gdb-end}
4949 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4950 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4951 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4952 @code{reset init})
4953 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4954 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4955 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4956 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4957 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4958 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4959 @item @b{gdb-start}
4960 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4961 @item @b{halted}
4962 @* The target has halted
4963 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4964 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4965 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4966 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4967 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4968 @item @b{reset-assert}
4969 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4970 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4971 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4972 it instead of asserting SRST.
4973 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4974 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4975 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4976 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4977 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4978 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4979 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4980 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4981 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4982 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4983 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4984 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4985 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4986 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4987 released on the scan chain.
4988 @item @b{reset-end}
4989 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4990 @item @b{reset-init}
4991 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4992 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4993
4994 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4995 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4996 multiplexing, and so on.
4997 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4998 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4999 @item @b{reset-start}
5000 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5001 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5002
5003 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5004 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5005 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5006 @item @b{resume-start}
5007 @* Before any target is resumed
5008 @item @b{resume-end}
5009 @* After all targets have resumed
5010 @item @b{resumed}
5011 @* Target has resumed
5012 @item @b{step-start}
5013 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5014 @item @b{step-end}
5015 @* After single-step has completed
5016 @item @b{trace-config}
5017 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5018 @end itemize
5019
5020 @quotation Note
5021 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5022 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5023 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5024 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5025 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5026 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5027 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5028 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5029 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5030 check if the core has changed status.
5031 @end quotation
5032
5033 @node Flash Commands
5034 @chapter Flash Commands
5035
5036 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5037 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5038 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5039 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5040 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5041 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5042 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5043 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5044 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5045
5046 Flash Steps:
5047 @enumerate
5048 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5049 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5050 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5051 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5052 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5053 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5054 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5055 @item GDB Flashing
5056 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5057 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5058 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5059 @end enumerate
5060
5061 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5062 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5063 so that it can't boot.
5064 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5065 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5066
5067 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5068 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5069 @cindex flash configuration
5070
5071 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5072 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5073 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5074 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5075 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5076 see the driver-specific documentation.
5077
5078 @itemize @bullet
5079 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5080 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5081 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5082 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5083 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5084 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5085 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5086 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5087 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5088 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5089 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5090 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5091 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5092 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5093 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5094 commands to the flash controller.
5095 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5096 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5097 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5098 for more information.
5099 @end itemize
5100 @quotation Note
5101 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5102 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5103 @end quotation
5104 @end deffn
5105
5106 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5107 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5108 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5109 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5110 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5111 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5112 @end deffn
5113
5114 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5115 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5116 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5117 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5118 @end deffn
5119
5120 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5121 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5122 depends on the flash type.
5123 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5124 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5125 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5126 but most don't bother.
5127 @end deffn
5128
5129 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5130
5131 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5132 begins.
5133
5134 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5135 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5136 until the programming session is finished.
5137
5138 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5139 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5140
5141 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5142
5143 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5144 @cindex flash erasing
5145 @cindex flash reading
5146 @cindex flash writing
5147 @cindex flash programming
5148 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5149
5150 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5151 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5152 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5153 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5154 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5155
5156 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5157 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5158 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5159 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5160 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5161
5162 @quotation Note
5163 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5164 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5165 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5166 back to a flash bank.
5167 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5168 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5169 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5170 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5171 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5172 @end quotation
5173
5174 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5175 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5176 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5177 disabled first.
5178 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5179 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5180 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5181
5182 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5183 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5184 up to and including @var{last}.
5185 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5186 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5187 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5188 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5189 @end deffn
5190
5191 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5192 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5193 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5194 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5195 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5196 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5197 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5198 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5199 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5200 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5201 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5202 before erase starts.
5203 @end deffn
5204
5205 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5206 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5207 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5208 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5209 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5210 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5211 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5212 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5213 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5214 before issuing this command.
5215 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5216 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5217 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5218 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5219 @end deffn
5220 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5221
5222 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5223 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5224 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5225 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5226 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5227 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5228 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5229 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5230 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5231 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5232 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5233 @end deffn
5234
5235 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5236 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5237 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5238 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5239 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5240 @end deffn
5241
5242 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5243 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5244 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5245 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5246 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5247 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5248 @end deffn
5249
5250 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5251 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5252 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5253 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5254 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5255 @end deffn
5256
5257 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5258 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5259 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5260 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5261 to the base address for each section in the image.
5262 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5263 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5264 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5265 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5266 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5267 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5268 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5269 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5270 each image section.
5271
5272 @quotation Warning
5273 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5274 data you want to preserve.
5275 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5276 sections might be erased with no notice.
5277 @itemize
5278 @item
5279 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5280 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5281 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5282 @item
5283 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5284 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5285 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5286 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5287 @end itemize
5288 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5289 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5290 @end quotation
5291
5292 @end deffn
5293
5294 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5295 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5296 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5297 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5298 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5299 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5300 ordinary memory reads.
5301 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5302 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5303 check for successful programming.
5304 @end deffn
5305
5306 @section Other Flash commands
5307 @cindex flash protection
5308
5309 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5310 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5311 and display that status.
5312 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5313 @end deffn
5314
5315 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5316 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5317 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5318
5319 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5320 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5321 and possibly stale information.
5322 @end deffn
5323
5324 @anchor{flashprotect}
5325 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5326 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5327 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5328 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5329 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5330 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5331 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5332 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5333 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5334 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5335 @end deffn
5336
5337 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5338 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5339 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5340 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5341 @end deffn
5342
5343 @anchor{program}
5344 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5345 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5346 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5347 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5348 @end deffn
5349
5350 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5351 @section Flash Driver List
5352 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5353 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5354 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5355
5356 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5357 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5358 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5359
5360 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5361
5362 @itemize
5363 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5364 @end itemize
5365
5366 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5367 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5368 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5369 @example
5370 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5371 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5372 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5373 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5374 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5375 @end example
5376 @end deffn
5377
5378 @subsection External Flash
5379
5380 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5381 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5382 @cindex CFI
5383 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5384 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5385 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5386 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5387 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5388 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5389 configure a bus and its timings), or
5390 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5391 on the flash chip.
5392 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5393 speed up operation.
5394
5395 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5396
5397 @itemize
5398 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5399 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5400 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5401 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5402 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5403 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5404 @end itemize
5405
5406 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5407 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5408
5409 @example
5410 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5411 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5412 @end example
5413
5414 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5415 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5416 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5417
5418 @example
5419 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5420 @end example
5421
5422 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5423 @end deffn
5424
5425 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5426 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5427 @cindex SPI
5428 @cindex jtagspi
5429 @cindex bscan_spi
5430 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5431 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5432 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5433 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5434 accessed through JTAG.
5435
5436 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5437 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5438 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5439 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5440 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5441 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5442
5443 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5444 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5445 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5446 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5447 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5448 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5449 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5450 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5451
5452 @itemize
5453 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5454 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5455 @var{USER1} instruction.
5456 @end itemize
5457
5458 @example
5459 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5460 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5461 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5462 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5463 @end example
5464 @end deffn
5465
5466 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5467 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5468 @cindex xcf
5469 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5470 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5471 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5472 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5473 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5474
5475 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5476 command accepts additional parameters:
5477 @itemize
5478 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5479 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5480 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5481 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5482 in master mode.
5483 @end itemize
5484 @example
5485 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5486 @end example
5487 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5488 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5489 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5490 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5491 dedicated sector.
5492 @end deffn
5493
5494 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5495 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5496 button.
5497 @example
5498 xcf configure 0
5499 @end example
5500 @end deffn
5501
5502 Additional driver notes:
5503 @itemize
5504 @item Only single revision supported.
5505 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5506 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5507 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5508 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5509 @end itemize
5510 @end deffn
5511
5512 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5513 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5514 @cindex SPIFI
5515 @cindex lpcspifi
5516 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5517 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5518 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5519
5520 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5521 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5522 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5523 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5524 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5525
5526 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5527 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5528 are configured by the driver.
5529
5530 @example
5531 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5532 @end example
5533
5534 @end deffn
5535
5536 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5537 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5538 @cindex SMI
5539 @cindex stmsmi
5540 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5541 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5542 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5543 SPI flash devices.
5544 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5545 flash devices can be connected.
5546
5547 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5548 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5549 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5550 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5551 the flash content.
5552
5553 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5554 to identify the memory bank.
5555 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5556 flash size, are detected automatically.
5557
5558 @example
5559 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5560 @end example
5561
5562 @end deffn
5563
5564 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5565 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5566 @cindex QuadSPI
5567 @cindex OctoSPI
5568 @cindex stmqspi
5569 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5570 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5571 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5572 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5573 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5574 mode is not.
5575
5576 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5577 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5578 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5579 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5580
5581 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5582 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5583 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5584
5585 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5586 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5587 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5588 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5589 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5590 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5591
5592 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5593 but only after proper controller initialization as decribed above. However,
5594 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5595 should be avoided.
5596
5597 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5598 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5599 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5600 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5601 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5602 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5603
5604 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5605 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5606 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5607 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5608 persist across openocd invocations.
5609
5610 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5611 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5612 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5613 required (see 'set' command).
5614
5615 @example
5616 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5617 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5618 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5619 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5620 @end example
5621
5622 There are three specific commands
5623 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5624 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5625 chip specific write protection engaged.
5626 @end deffn
5627
5628 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5629 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5630 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5631 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5632 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5633 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5634
5635 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5636 which don't support an id command.
5637
5638 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5639 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5640 @end deffn
5641
5642 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5643 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5644 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5645 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5646 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5647
5648 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5649 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5650 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5651 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5652
5653 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5654
5655 To check basic communication settings, issue
5656 @example
5657 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5658 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5659 @end example
5660 for single flash mode or
5661 @example
5662 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5663 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5664 @end example
5665 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5666
5667 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5668 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5669 need a dummy address, e.g.
5670 @example
5671 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5672 @end example
5673 should return the status register contents.
5674
5675 @end deffn
5676
5677 @end deffn
5678
5679 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5680 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5681 Microcontroller platform.
5682
5683 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5684 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5685
5686 @example
5687 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5688 @end example
5689
5690 @end deffn
5691
5692 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5693 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5694 @cindex ath79
5695 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5696 chip selects.
5697 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5698 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5699 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5700 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5701 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5702 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5703
5704 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5705 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5706 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5707 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5708 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5709 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5710 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5711 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5712 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5713 with the default CS0.
5714 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5715 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5716 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5717
5718 @example
5719 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5720
5721 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5722 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5723 # distinguish the banks.
5724 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5725 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5726 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5727 @end example
5728
5729 @end deffn
5730
5731 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5732 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5733 @cindex fespi
5734
5735 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5736
5737 @example
5738 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5739 @end example
5740 @end deffn
5741
5742 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5743
5744 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5745 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5746 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5747 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5748 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5749 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5750
5751 @example
5752 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5753 @end example
5754 @end deffn
5755
5756 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5757 @cindex ambiqmicro
5758 @cindex apollo
5759 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5760 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5761 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5762 with the target using SWD.
5763
5764 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5765 the device class of the MCU.
5766 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5767 to set up the flash banks.
5768 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5769 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5770
5771 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5772 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5773 and the second bank starts after the first.
5774
5775 @example
5776 # Flash bank 0
5777 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5778 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5779 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5780 $_TARGETNAME
5781 @end example
5782
5783 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5784 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5785 are available to the user.
5786
5787 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5788
5789 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5790 Erase entire bank.
5791 @end deffn
5792 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5793 Erase device pages.
5794 @end deffn
5795 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5796 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5797 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5798 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5799 the flash.
5800 @end deffn
5801 @end deffn
5802
5803 @anchor{at91samd}
5804 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5805 @cindex at91samd
5806 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5807 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5808
5809 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5810
5811 The devices have one flash bank:
5812
5813 @example
5814 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5815 @end example
5816
5817 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5818 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5819 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5820 processor to be halted.
5821 @end deffn
5822
5823 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5824 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5825 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5826 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5827 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5828 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5829
5830 @example
5831 at91samd set-security enable
5832 @end example
5833 @end deffn
5834
5835 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5836 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5837 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5838 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5839 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5840 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5841 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5842 in order to disable this feature.
5843
5844 @example
5845 at91samd eeprom
5846 at91samd eeprom 1024
5847 @end example
5848 @end deffn
5849
5850 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
5851 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5852 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5853 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5854 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5855 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5856
5857 @example
5858 at91samd bootloader
5859 at91samd bootloader 16384
5860 @end example
5861 @end deffn
5862
5863 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5864 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5865 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5866 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5867 @end deffn
5868
5869 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5870 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5871 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5872 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5873 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5874 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5875 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5876 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5877
5878 @example
5879 # Read user row
5880 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5881 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5882 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5883 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5884 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
5885 # byte unchanged
5886 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5887 @end example
5888 @end deffn
5889
5890 @end deffn
5891
5892 @anchor{at91sam3}
5893 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
5894 @cindex at91sam3
5895 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5896 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5897 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5898 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5899 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5900 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5901 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5902 chips are confirmed.}
5903
5904 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5905 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5906 the following fixed locations:
5907
5908 @example
5909 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5910 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5911 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5912 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5913 @end example
5914
5915 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5916 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5917 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5918
5919 @itemize
5920 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5921 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5922 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5923 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5924 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5925 @end itemize
5926
5927 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5928
5929 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5930 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5931 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5932 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5933 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5934 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5935 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5936
5937 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5938 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5939 @end deffn
5940
5941 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
5942 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5943 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5944 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5945 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5946 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5947 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5948 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5949 @end deffn
5950
5951 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5952 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5953 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5954 @end deffn
5955 @end deffn
5956
5957 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
5958 @cindex at91sam4
5959 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5960 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5961 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5962 @end deffn
5963
5964 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
5965 @cindex at91sam4l
5966 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5967 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5968 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5969
5970 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5971 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5972 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5973 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5974 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5975 @end deffn
5976 @end deffn
5977
5978 @anchor{atsame5}
5979 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
5980 @cindex atsame5
5981 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5982 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5983 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5984
5985 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5986 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5987 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5988
5989 @example
5990 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5991 @end example
5992
5993 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
5994 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5995 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5996 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5997 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5998 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5999
6000 @example
6001 atsame5 bootloader
6002 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6003 @end example
6004 @end deffn
6005
6006 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6007 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6008 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6009 processor to be halted.
6010 @end deffn
6011
6012 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6013 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6014 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6015 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6016 @end deffn
6017
6018 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6019 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6020 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6021 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6022 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6023 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6024 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6025 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6026
6027 @example
6028 # Read
6029 >atsame5 userpage
6030 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6031 # Write
6032 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6033 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6034 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6035 # bytes)
6036 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6037 @end example
6038 @end deffn
6039
6040 @end deffn
6041
6042 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6043 @cindex atsamv
6044 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6045 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6046 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6047 @end deffn
6048
6049 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6050 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6051 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6052 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6053 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6054
6055 @example
6056 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6057 @end example
6058
6059 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6060 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6061
6062 @itemize
6063 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6064 @item @var{banks}
6065 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6066 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6067 @item @var{pages_size}
6068 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6069 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6070 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6071 @end itemize
6072
6073 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6074 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6075 will be autoconfigured.
6076 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6077
6078 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6079 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6080 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6081 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6082 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6083
6084 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6085 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6086 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6087 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6088 are not truly general purpose).
6089 @quotation Note
6090 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6091 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6092 @end quotation
6093 @end deffn
6094 @end deffn
6095
6096 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6097 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6098 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6099 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6100 @end deffn
6101
6102 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6103 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6104 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6105 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6106
6107 @example
6108 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6109 @end example
6110
6111 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6112 each single sector one by one.
6113
6114 @example
6115 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6116 @end example
6117
6118 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6119 @end deffn
6120
6121 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6122 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6123 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6124 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6125 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6126 starts at address 0.
6127
6128 @example
6129 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6130 @end example
6131 @end deffn
6132
6133 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6134 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6135 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6136 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6137 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6138 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6139 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6140 and programming the serial flash.
6141
6142 @example
6143 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6144 @end example
6145 @end deffn
6146
6147 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6148 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6149 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6150 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6151 autoconfigures itself.
6152 @example
6153 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6154 @end example
6155 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6156 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6157 this via the following command:
6158 @example
6159 efm32 debuglock num
6160 @end example
6161 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6162 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6163 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6164 supported.}
6165 @end deffn
6166
6167 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6168 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6169 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6170 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6171 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6172 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6173
6174 @example
6175 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6176 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6177 @end example
6178
6179 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6180 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6181 @end deffn
6182
6183 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6184 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6185 is an uncommon operation.}
6186 @end deffn
6187 @end deffn
6188
6189 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6190 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6191 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6192 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6193 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6194 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6195 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6196
6197 @example
6198 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6199 @end example
6200 @end deffn
6201
6202 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6203 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6204 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6205 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6206 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6207 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6208 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6209 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6210 characters) ignored.
6211
6212 @example
6213 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6214 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6215 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6216 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6217 @end example
6218 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6219 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6220 @end deffn
6221
6222 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6223 @cindex kinetis
6224 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6225 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6226 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6227 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6228 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6229 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6230
6231 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6232 @itemize
6233 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6234 @end itemize
6235
6236 @example
6237 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6238 @end example
6239
6240 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6241 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6242 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6243 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6244 @end deffn
6245
6246 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6247 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6248 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6249 set by 'flash protect' command.
6250 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6251 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6252 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6253 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6254 with the rest of a flash image.
6255 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6256 @end deffn
6257
6258 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6259 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6260 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6261 @end deffn
6262
6263 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6264 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6265 and examine-fail event.
6266 @end deffn
6267
6268 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6269 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6270 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6271 @end deffn
6272
6273 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6274 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6275 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6276 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6277 command completes.
6278 @end deffn
6279
6280 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6281 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6282 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6283 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6284 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6285
6286 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6287 Program Partition command.
6288
6289 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6290 Reset the device after partition setting.
6291
6292 Show partition size:
6293 @example
6294 kinetis nvm_partition info
6295 @end example
6296
6297 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6298 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6299 @example
6300 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6301 @end example
6302
6303 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6304 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6305 @example
6306 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6307 @end example
6308 @end deffn
6309
6310 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6311 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6312 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6313 @end deffn
6314
6315 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6316 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6317 Command disables watchdog timer.
6318 @end deffn
6319 @end deffn
6320
6321 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6322 @cindex kinetis_ke
6323 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6324 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6325 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6326 autoconfigures itself.
6327 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6328
6329 @example
6330 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6331 @end example
6332
6333 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6334 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6335 @end deffn
6336
6337 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6338 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6339 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6340 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6341 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6342 @end deffn
6343
6344 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6345 Command disables watchdog timer.
6346 @end deffn
6347 @end deffn
6348
6349 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6350 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6351 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6352 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6353 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6354
6355 @quotation Note
6356 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6357 driver:
6358 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6359 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6360 @end quotation
6361
6362 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6363 which must appear in the following order:
6364
6365 @itemize
6366 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6367 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6368 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6369 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6370 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6371 LPC43x[2357])
6372 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6373 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6374 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6375 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6376 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6377 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6378 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6379 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6380 at which the core is running
6381 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6382 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6383 @quotation Note
6384 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6385 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6386 However, if you do provide it,
6387 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6388 @end quotation
6389 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6390 ROM IAP entry point.
6391 @end itemize
6392
6393 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6394
6395 @example
6396 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6397 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6398 @end example
6399
6400 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6401 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6402 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6403 @end deffn
6404 @end deffn
6405
6406 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6407 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6408 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6409 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6410 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6411 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6412
6413 @example
6414 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6415 @end example
6416 @end deffn
6417
6418 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6419 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6420 from NXP.
6421
6422 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6423 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6424 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6425 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6426 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6427 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6428 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6429 you start the PLL.
6430
6431 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6432
6433 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6434 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6435 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6436
6437 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6438 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6439 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6440 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6441 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6442 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6443 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6444
6445 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6446 @example
6447 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6448 @end example
6449
6450 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6451 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6452 @code{flash banks} command.
6453
6454 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6455 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6456 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6457 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6458 a known signature.
6459 Example:
6460 @example
6461 lpc2900 signature 0
6462 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6463 @end example
6464 @end deffn
6465
6466 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6467 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6468 saves it to a file in binary format.
6469 Example:
6470 @example
6471 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6472 @end example
6473 @end deffn
6474
6475 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6476 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6477 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6478 command:
6479
6480 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6481 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6482 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6483 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6484
6485 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6486 Example:
6487 @example
6488 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6489 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6490 @end example
6491 @end deffn
6492
6493 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6494 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6495 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6496 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6497 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6498 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6499 912 bytes.
6500 @quotation Attention
6501 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6502 @end quotation
6503 Example:
6504 @example
6505 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6506 @end example
6507 @end deffn
6508
6509 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6510 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6511 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6512 after the next power cycle.
6513 @quotation Attention
6514 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6515 @end quotation
6516 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6517 Example:
6518 @example
6519 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6520 flash info 0
6521 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6522 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6523 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6524 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6525 @end example
6526 @end deffn
6527
6528 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6529 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6530 effective after the next power cycle.
6531 @quotation Attention
6532 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6533 @end quotation
6534 Examples:
6535 @example
6536 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6537 @end example
6538 @end deffn
6539 @end deffn
6540
6541 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6542 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6543 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6544 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6545
6546 @example
6547 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6548 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6549 @end example
6550
6551 @itemize @bullet
6552 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6553 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6554 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6555 @end itemize
6556
6557 Example usage:
6558 @example
6559 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6560 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6561 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6562 @} else @{
6563 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6564 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6565 @}
6566 @end example
6567 @end deffn
6568
6569 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6570 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6571 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6572 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6573 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6574 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6575
6576 @example
6577 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6578 @end example
6579
6580 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6581 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6582 only the main program flash.
6583
6584 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6585 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6586 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6587 @end deffn
6588
6589 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6590 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6591 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6592 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6593
6594 To erase and program the BSL:
6595 @example
6596 msp432 bsl unlock
6597 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6598 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6599 msp432 bsl lock
6600 @end example
6601 @end deffn
6602 @end deffn
6603
6604 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6605 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6606 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6607 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6608 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6609 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6610 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6611 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6612 also have division into regions: main and info.
6613 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6614 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6615
6616 @example
6617 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6618 @end example
6619
6620 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6621
6622 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6623 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6624 @end deffn
6625
6626 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6627 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6628 @end deffn
6629
6630 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6631 Erase all userflash including info region.
6632 @end deffn
6633
6634 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6635 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6636 @end deffn
6637
6638 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6639 Check sectors protect.
6640 @end deffn
6641
6642 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6643 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6644 @end deffn
6645
6646 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6647 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6648 @end deffn
6649
6650 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6651 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6652 @end deffn
6653
6654 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6655 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6656 @end deffn
6657
6658 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6659 Show information about flash driver.
6660 @end deffn
6661
6662 @end deffn
6663
6664 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6665 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6666 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6667 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6668 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6669
6670 @example
6671 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6672 @end example
6673
6674 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6675
6676 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6677 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6678 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6679 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6680 code.
6681 @end deffn
6682
6683 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6684 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6685 @end deffn
6686
6687 @end deffn
6688
6689 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6690 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6691 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6692
6693 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6694 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6695 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6696 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6697
6698 @example
6699 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6700 @end example
6701 @end deffn
6702
6703 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6704 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6705 and integrate flash memory.
6706
6707 @example
6708 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6709 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6710 @end example
6711
6712 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6713 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6714 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6715 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6716 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6717 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6718 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6719 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6720 @end deffn
6721 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6722 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6723 This will remove any Code Protection.
6724 @end deffn
6725 @end deffn
6726
6727 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6728 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6729 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6730 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6731 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6732
6733 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6734 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6735
6736 @example
6737 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6738 @end example
6739
6740 psoc4-specific commands
6741 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6742 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6743
6744 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6745 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6746
6747 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6748 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6749 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6750
6751 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6752 @end deffn
6753
6754 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6755 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6756
6757 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6758 @end deffn
6759 @end deffn
6760
6761 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6762 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6763 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6764 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6765 apart from the base address.
6766
6767 @example
6768 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6769 @end example
6770
6771 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6772 @quotation Attention
6773 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6774 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6775 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6776 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6777 @end quotation
6778
6779 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6780
6781 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6782 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6783 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6784 @end deffn
6785 @end deffn
6786
6787 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6788 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6789 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6790 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6791 apart from the base address.
6792
6793 @example
6794 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6795 $_TARGETNAME
6796 @end example
6797 @end deffn
6798
6799 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6800 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6801 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6802 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6803
6804 @example
6805 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6806 @end example
6807
6808 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6809
6810 @itemize
6811 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6812 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6813 @end itemize
6814
6815 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6816
6817 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6818 @quotation Attention
6819 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6820 after successful write.
6821 @end quotation
6822 @end deffn
6823
6824 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
6825 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6826 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6827 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6828
6829 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6830 @itemize @bullet
6831 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6832 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6833 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6834 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6835 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6836 row size: 512 bytes.
6837 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6838 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6839 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6840 operation will erase row automatically.
6841 @end itemize
6842
6843 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6844 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6845
6846 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6847
6848 @example
6849 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6850 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6851 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6852 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6853 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6854 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6855 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6856 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6857 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6858 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6859 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6860 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6861
6862 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6863 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6864 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6865 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6866 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6867 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6868 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6869 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6870 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6871 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6872 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6873 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6874 @end example
6875
6876 psoc6-specific commands
6877 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
6878 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6879 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6880 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6881 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6882 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6883 @end deffn
6884
6885 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6886 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6887 by @command{flash banks}.
6888 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6889 @end deffn
6890 @end deffn
6891
6892 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
6893 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6894 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6895 and SWD interface.
6896 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6897 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6898
6899 @example
6900 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6901 @end example
6902
6903 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6904
6905 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
6906 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6907 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6908 @end deffn
6909
6910 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
6911 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6912 @end deffn
6913 @end deffn
6914
6915 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
6916 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6917 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6918 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6919 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6920
6921 @example
6922 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6923 @end example
6924
6925 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
6926 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6927 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6928 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6929 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6930 disabled.
6931
6932 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6933 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6934 @quotation Warning
6935 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6936 applied to all of them.
6937 @end quotation
6938 @end deffn
6939 @end deffn
6940
6941 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
6942 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6943 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6944 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6945 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6946
6947 @example
6948 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6949 @end example
6950
6951 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6952 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6953 the flash driver.
6954
6955 @example
6956 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6957 @end example
6958
6959 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6960 as per the following example.
6961 @example
6962 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6963 @end example
6964
6965 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6966
6967 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
6968 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6969 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6970 @end deffn
6971
6972 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
6973 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6974 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6975 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6976 @end deffn
6977
6978 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6979 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6980 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6981 @end deffn
6982
6983 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
6984 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6985 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6986 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6987 @end deffn
6988
6989 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6990 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6991 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6992 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6993 @end deffn
6994
6995 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
6996 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6997 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6998 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6999 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7000 @end deffn
7001 @end deffn
7002
7003 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7004 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7005 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7006 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7007 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7008
7009 @example
7010 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7011 @end example
7012
7013 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7014 as per the following example.
7015 @example
7016 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7017 @end example
7018
7019 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7020 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7021 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7022 @end deffn
7023
7024 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7025 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7026 the flash driver.
7027
7028 @example
7029 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7030 @end example
7031
7032 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7033
7034 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7035 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7036 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7037 @end deffn
7038
7039 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7040 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7041 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7042 @end deffn
7043
7044 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7045 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7046 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7047 @end deffn
7048
7049 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7050 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7051 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7052 @end deffn
7053
7054 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7055 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7056 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7057 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7058 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7059 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7060 @end deffn
7061
7062 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7063 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7064 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7065 @end deffn
7066 @end deffn
7067
7068 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7069 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7070 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7071 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7072 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7073
7074 @example
7075 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7076 @end example
7077
7078 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7079 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7080 the flash driver.
7081
7082 @example
7083 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7084 @end example
7085
7086 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7087
7088 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7089 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7090 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7091 @end deffn
7092
7093 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7094 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7095 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7096 @end deffn
7097
7098 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7099 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7100 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7101 @end deffn
7102
7103 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7104 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7105 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7106 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7107 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7108
7109 Example usage:
7110 @example
7111 # read OPTSR_CUR
7112 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7113 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7114 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7115 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7116 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7117 @end example
7118 @end deffn
7119
7120 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7121 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7122 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7123 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7124 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7125 will be touched).
7126
7127 Example usage:
7128 @example
7129 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7130 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7131 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7132 @end example
7133 @end deffn
7134 @end deffn
7135
7136 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7137 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7138 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7139 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7140 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7141
7142 @example
7143 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7144 @end example
7145
7146 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7147 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7148 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7149 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7150 second bank.
7151
7152 @example
7153 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7154 @end example
7155
7156 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7157
7158 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7159 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7160 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7161 @end deffn
7162
7163 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7164 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7165 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7166 @end deffn
7167
7168 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7169 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7170 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7171 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7172 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7173 @end deffn
7174 @end deffn
7175
7176 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7177 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, WB and WL
7178 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7179 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7180 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7181 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7182
7183 @example
7184 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7185 @end example
7186
7187 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7188 as per the following example.
7189 @example
7190 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7191 @end example
7192
7193 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7194 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7195 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7196 @end deffn
7197
7198 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7199 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7200 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7201 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7202
7203 @example
7204 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7205 @end example
7206
7207 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7208
7209 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7210 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7211 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7212 @end deffn
7213
7214 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7215 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7216 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7217 @end deffn
7218
7219 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7220 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7221 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7222 @end deffn
7223
7224 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7225 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7226 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7227 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7228
7229 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7230 @example
7231 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7232 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7233 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7234 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7235 @end example
7236
7237 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7238 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7239 @end deffn
7240
7241 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7242 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7243 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7244 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7245 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7246
7247 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7248 @example
7249 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7250 @end example
7251
7252 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7253 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7254 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7255 @end deffn
7256
7257 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7258 List the protected areas using WRP.
7259 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7260 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7261 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7262
7263 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7264 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7265 in single or dual-banks mode.
7266 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7267 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7268
7269 @end deffn
7270
7271 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7272 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7273 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7274 @end deffn
7275 @end deffn
7276
7277 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7278 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7279 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7280 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7281 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7282
7283 @example
7284 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7285 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7286 @end example
7287
7288 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7289 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7290 for the specified flash bank.
7291 @end deffn
7292 @end deffn
7293
7294 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7295 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7296 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7297 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7298 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7299
7300 @example
7301 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7302 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7303 @end example
7304
7305 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7306 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7307 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7308
7309 @itemize @bullet
7310 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7311 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7312 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7313 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7314 @end itemize
7315 @end deffn
7316
7317 @end deffn
7318
7319 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7320 @cindex str9xpec
7321
7322 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7323 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7324 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7325 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7326
7327 Here is some background info to help
7328 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7329 the str9:
7330 @enumerate
7331 @item
7332 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7333 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7334 @item
7335 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7336 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7337 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7338 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7339 @end enumerate
7340
7341 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7342 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7343 configured for flash bank 0.
7344 @example
7345 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7346 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7347 adapter assert srst
7348 # turn off target polling
7349 poll off
7350 # disable str9 core
7351 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7352 # read option bytes
7353 str9xpec options_read 0
7354 # re-enable str9 core
7355 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7356 poll on
7357 reset halt
7358 @end example
7359 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7360 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7361 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7362 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7363
7364 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7365
7366 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7367 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7368 @end deffn
7369
7370 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7371 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7372 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7373 @end deffn
7374
7375 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7376 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7377 erase the device.
7378 @end deffn
7379
7380 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7381 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7382 @end deffn
7383
7384 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7385 Configure str9 boot bank.
7386 @end deffn
7387
7388 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7389 Configure str9 lvd source.
7390 @end deffn
7391
7392 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7393 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7394 @end deffn
7395
7396 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7397 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7398 @end deffn
7399
7400 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7401 Read str9 option bytes.
7402 @end deffn
7403
7404 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7405 Write str9 option bytes.
7406 @end deffn
7407
7408 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7409 unlock str9 device.
7410 @end deffn
7411
7412 @end deffn
7413
7414 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7415 @cindex swm050
7416 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7417
7418 @example
7419 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7420 @end example
7421
7422 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7423
7424 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7425 Erases the entire flash bank.
7426 @end deffn
7427
7428 @end deffn
7429
7430
7431 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7432 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7433 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7434 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7435
7436 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7437
7438 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7439 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7440 @end deffn
7441
7442 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7443 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7444 @end deffn
7445
7446 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7447 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7448 the flash clock.
7449 @end deffn
7450 @end deffn
7451
7452 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7453 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7454 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7455 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7456 correct bank config.
7457
7458 @example
7459 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7460 @end example
7461 @end deffn
7462
7463 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7464 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7465 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7466 @end deffn
7467
7468 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7469 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7470 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7471
7472 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7473
7474 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7475 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7476 @end deffn
7477
7478 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7479 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7480 @end deffn
7481
7482 @end deffn
7483
7484 @section NAND Flash Commands
7485 @cindex NAND
7486
7487 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7488 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7489 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7490
7491 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7492 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7493 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7494 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7495 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7496 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7497
7498 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7499 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7500 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7501 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7502 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7503 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7504 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7505 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7506 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7507 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7508
7509 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7510 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7511 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7512 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7513 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7514 every 512 bytes of data.
7515
7516 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7517 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7518 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7519 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7520 ECC mode is used.
7521
7522 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7523 @enumerate
7524 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7525 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7526 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7527 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7528 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7529 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7530 to access that device.
7531 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7532 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7533 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7534 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7535 de-brick a board.
7536 @end enumerate
7537
7538 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7539 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7540 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7541 are only 32 bits wide.
7542 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7543 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7544 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7545 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7546
7547 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7548 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7549 @cindex NAND configuration
7550
7551 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7552 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7553 OpenOCD has initialized.
7554
7555 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7556 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7557 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7558 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7559 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7560 they were a single (larger) device.
7561 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7562 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7563
7564 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7565 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7566 configuration files, not interactively.
7567
7568 @itemize @bullet
7569 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7570 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7571 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7572 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7573 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7574 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7575 commands to the NAND controller.
7576 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7577 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7578 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7579 for more information.
7580 @end itemize
7581 @end deffn
7582
7583 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7584 Prints a summary of each device declared
7585 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7586 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7587 @example
7588 > nand list
7589 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7590 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7591 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7592 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7593 >
7594 @end example
7595 @end deffn
7596
7597 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7598 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7599 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7600 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7601 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7602 it with most other NAND commands.
7603 @end deffn
7604
7605 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7606
7607 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7608 @cindex NAND reading
7609 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7610 starting at the specified offset.
7611 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7612
7613 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7614 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7615
7616 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7617 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7618 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7619
7620 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7621 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7622 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7623 method which handled that error correction.
7624
7625 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7626 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7627 @itemize @bullet
7628 @item no oob_* parameter
7629 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7630 @item @code{oob_raw}
7631 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7632 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7633 spare areas associated with each data page.
7634 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7635 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7636 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7637 @item @code{oob_only}
7638 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7639 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7640 spare areas associated with each data page.
7641 @end itemize
7642 @end deffn
7643
7644 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7645 @cindex NAND erasing
7646 @cindex NAND programming
7647 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7648 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7649 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7650 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7651 If those parameters are not specified,
7652 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7653 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7654
7655 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7656 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7657 block marker.
7658 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7659 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7660 @end deffn
7661
7662 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7663 @cindex NAND writing
7664 @cindex NAND programming
7665 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7666 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7667 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7668 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7669
7670 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7671 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7672
7673 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7674 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7675 past the end of the device.
7676 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7677 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7678 if that's being written.)
7679
7680 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7681 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7682 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7683
7684 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7685 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7686 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7687 @itemize @bullet
7688 @item no oob_* parameter
7689 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7690 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7691 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7692 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7693 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7694 @item @code{oob_only}
7695 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7696 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7697 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7698 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7699 @item @code{oob_raw}
7700 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7701 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7702 un-altered OOB.
7703 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7704 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7705 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7706 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7707 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7708 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7709 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7710 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7711 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7712 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7713 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7714 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7715 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7716 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7717 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7718 @end itemize
7719 @end deffn
7720
7721 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7722 @cindex NAND verification
7723 @cindex NAND programming
7724 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7725 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7726 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7727
7728 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7729 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7730
7731 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7732 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7733 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7734 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7735 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7736
7737 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7738 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7739 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7740
7741 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7742 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7743 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7744 be removed in a future release.
7745 @end deffn
7746
7747 @subsection Other NAND commands
7748 @cindex NAND other commands
7749
7750 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7751 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7752 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7753 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7754 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7755 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7756 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7757 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7758
7759 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7760 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7761 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7762 @end deffn
7763
7764 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7765 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7766 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7767 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7768 status for each block.
7769 @end deffn
7770
7771 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7772 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7773 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7774
7775 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7776 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7777 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7778 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7779 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7780
7781 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7782 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7783 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7784 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7785 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7786 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7787 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7788 @end deffn
7789
7790 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7791 @subsection NAND Driver List
7792 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7793 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7794 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7795
7796 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
7797 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7798 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7799 address of the ECC controller.
7800 @example
7801 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7802 @end example
7803 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7804 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7805 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7806 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7807 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7808 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7809 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7810 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7811 @end deffn
7812 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7813 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7814 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7815 @end deffn
7816
7817 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7818 properly configured for input or output.
7819 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7820 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7821 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7822 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7823 @end deffn
7824 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7825 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7826 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7827 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7828 @end deffn
7829 @end deffn
7830
7831 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
7832 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7833 chips from Texas Instruments.
7834 It takes three extra parameters:
7835 address of the NAND chip;
7836 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7837 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7838 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7839 @example
7840 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7841 @end example
7842 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7843 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7844 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7845 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7846 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7847 @end deffn
7848
7849 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
7850 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7851 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7852 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7853 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7854 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7855 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7856 @end deffn
7857
7858 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7859 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7860 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7861 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7862 @end deffn
7863 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7864
7865 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
7866 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7867 should work for this chip as well.
7868 @end deffn
7869
7870 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
7871 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7872 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7873 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7874 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7875 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7876 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7877 @example
7878 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7879 @end example
7880 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7881 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7882 without parameter query status.
7883 @end deffn
7884 @end deffn
7885
7886 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
7887 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7888 parameter: the address of the controller.
7889 @example
7890 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7891 @end example
7892 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7893 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7894 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7895 change any behavior.
7896 @end deffn
7897
7898 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
7899 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
7900 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
7901 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
7902 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
7903 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7904 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7905 specialized commands.
7906 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7907 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7908 change any behavior.
7909 @end deffn
7910
7911 @node Flash Programming
7912 @chapter Flash Programming
7913
7914 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7915 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7916 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7917
7918 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7919 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7920
7921 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7922 @enumerate
7923 @item 'init' is executed.
7924 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7925 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7926 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7927 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7928 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7929 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7930 @end enumerate
7931
7932 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7933
7934 @example
7935 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7936 # are optional parameters
7937 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7938 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7939
7940 # binary files need the flash address passing
7941 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7942 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7943 @end example
7944
7945 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7946 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7947 @cindex PLD
7948 @cindex FPGA
7949
7950 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7951 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7952 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7953 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7954 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7955 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7956 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7957
7958 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7959
7960 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7961 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7962 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7963
7964 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7965 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7966
7967 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7968 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7969 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7970 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7971 behavior.
7972 @end deffn
7973
7974 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7975 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7976 @end deffn
7977
7978 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7979 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7980 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7981 @end deffn
7982
7983 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7984
7985 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7986 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7987 that particular type of PLD.
7988
7989 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
7990 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7991 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7992
7993 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7994 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7995 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7996
7997 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7998 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7999 for FPGA @var{num}.
8000 @end deffn
8001 @end deffn
8002
8003 @node General Commands
8004 @chapter General Commands
8005 @cindex commands
8006
8007 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8008 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8009 commands are documented elsewhere.
8010
8011 Intent:
8012 @itemize @bullet
8013 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8014 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8015 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8016 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8017
8018 @item @b{From the human}
8019 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8020 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8021
8022 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8023 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8024 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8025
8026 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8027 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8028 port is 5555.
8029 @end itemize
8030
8031
8032 @section Server Commands
8033
8034 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8035 Exits the current telnet session.
8036 @end deffn
8037
8038 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8039 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8040 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8041 Not every command provides helptext.
8042
8043 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8044 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8045 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8046 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8047 @end deffn
8048
8049 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8050 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8051 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8052 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8053 Useful in connection with script files
8054 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8055 @end deffn
8056
8057 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8058 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8059 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8060 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8061
8062 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8063 @example
8064 # redefine shutdown
8065 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8066 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8067 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8068 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8069 original_shutdown
8070 @}
8071 @end example
8072 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8073 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8074 @end deffn
8075
8076 @anchor{debuglevel}
8077 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8078 @cindex message level
8079 Display debug level.
8080 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8081 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8082 Level 0 is error messages only;
8083 level 1 adds warnings;
8084 level 2 adds informational messages;
8085 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8086 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8087 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8088 the command line along with the location of that log
8089 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8090 @xref{Running}.
8091 @end deffn
8092
8093 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8094 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8095 Output @var{message} to stdout.
8096 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8097 @example
8098 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8099 @end example
8100 @end deffn
8101
8102 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8103 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8104 the default log output channel is stderr.
8105 @end deffn
8106
8107 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8108 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8109 @end deffn
8110
8111 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8112 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8113 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8114 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8115 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8116 @end deffn
8117
8118 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8119 @section Target State handling
8120 @cindex reset
8121 @cindex halt
8122 @cindex target initialization
8123
8124 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8125 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8126 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8127 a current target which is used to perform the
8128 various operations. The current target may be changed
8129 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8130 target which should become current.
8131
8132 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8133 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8134 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8135 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8136 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8137
8138 @emph{With no arguments}:
8139 list all available registers for the current target,
8140 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8141 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8142 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8143 are flagged as such.
8144
8145 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8146 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8147 bypassing any internal cache.
8148
8149 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8150 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8151 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8152 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8153 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8154 relevant module will flush such values.
8155
8156 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8157 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8158
8159 @example
8160 > reg
8161 ===== ARM registers
8162 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8163 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8164 (2) r2 (/32)
8165 ...
8166 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8167 >
8168 @end example
8169 @end deffn
8170
8171 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8172 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8173 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8174 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8175 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8176 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8177 (and enter debug mode).
8178 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8179
8180 @quotation Warning
8181 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8182 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8183 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8184 power mode by gating the core clock;
8185 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8186
8187 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8188 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8189 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8190 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8191 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8192 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8193
8194 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8195 work with a JTAG debugger.
8196 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8197 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8198 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8199 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8200 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8201 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8202 @end quotation
8203
8204 @end deffn
8205
8206 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8207 Resume the target at its current code position,
8208 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8209 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8210 @end deffn
8211
8212 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8213 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8214 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8215 @end deffn
8216
8217 @anchor{resetcommand}
8218 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8219 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8220 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8221 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8222 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8223 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8224 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8225
8226 The optional parameter specifies what should
8227 happen after the reset.
8228 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8229 The other options will not work on all systems.
8230 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8231
8232 @itemize @minus
8233 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8234 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8235 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8236 @end itemize
8237 @end deffn
8238
8239 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8240 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8241 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8242 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8243 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8244 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8245 state.
8246 @end deffn
8247
8248 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8249 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8250 Set values of reset signals.
8251 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8252 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8253 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8254 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8255
8256 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8257 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8258 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8259 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8260 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8261 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8262 the signal will not be modified.
8263
8264 @quotation Note
8265 TRST is specially handled.
8266 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8267 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8268 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8269 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8270 instead of the TRST signal.
8271 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8272 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8273 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8274 with handlers for that event.
8275 @end quotation
8276 @end deffn
8277
8278 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8279 @section Memory access commands
8280 @cindex memory access
8281
8282 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8283 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8284 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8285 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8286
8287 @enumerate
8288 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8289 to change the current target.
8290 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8291 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8292 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8293 @end enumerate
8294
8295 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8296 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8297 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8298 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8299 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8300 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8301 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8302 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8303 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8304 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8305 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8306 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8307 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8308 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8309 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8310 @end deffn
8311
8312 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8313 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8314 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8315 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8316 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8317 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8318 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8319 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8320 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8321 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8322 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8323 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8324 @end deffn
8325
8326 @anchor{imageaccess}
8327 @section Image loading commands
8328 @cindex image loading
8329 @cindex image dumping
8330
8331 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8332 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8333 binary file named @var{filename}.
8334 @end deffn
8335
8336 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8337 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8338 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8339 @end deffn
8340
8341 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8342 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8343 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8344 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8345 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8346 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8347 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8348 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8349 separately.
8350 @end deffn
8351
8352 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8353 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8354 The file format may optionally be specified
8355 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8356 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8357 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8358 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8359 @example
8360 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8361 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8362 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8363 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8364 $address $length
8365 @}
8366 @end example
8367 @end deffn
8368
8369 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8370 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8371 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8372 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8373 The file format may optionally be specified
8374 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8375 @end deffn
8376
8377 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8378 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8379 The file format may optionally be specified
8380 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8381 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8382 @end deffn
8383
8384 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8385 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8386 The file format may optionally be specified
8387 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8388 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8389 @end deffn
8390
8391
8392 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8393 @cindex breakpoint
8394 @cindex watchpoint
8395
8396 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8397 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8398 watchpoints.
8399 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8400
8401 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8402 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8403 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8404 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8405 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8406 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8407
8408 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8409 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8410 @end deffn
8411
8412 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8413 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8414 @end deffn
8415
8416 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8417 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8418 @end deffn
8419
8420 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8421 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8422 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8423 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8424 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8425 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8426 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8427 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8428 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8429 @end deffn
8430
8431
8432 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8433
8434 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8435 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8436 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8437 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8438 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8439 running, can be used.
8440 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8441 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8442 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8443
8444 @quotation Note
8445 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8446 @end quotation
8447
8448 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8449 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8450 communication, respectively.
8451
8452 @quotation Note
8453 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8454 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8455 example.
8456 @end quotation
8457
8458 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8459 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8460 of TCP/IP connections.
8461
8462 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8463 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8464 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8465 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8466 @var{size} bytes.
8467 @end deffn
8468
8469 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8470 Start RTT.
8471 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8472 @end deffn
8473
8474 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8475 Stop RTT.
8476 @end deffn
8477
8478 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
8479 Display the polling interval.
8480 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8481 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8482 checked for new data.
8483 @end deffn
8484
8485 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8486 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8487 @end deffn
8488
8489 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8490 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8491 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8492 @end deffn
8493
8494 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8495 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8496 @end deffn
8497
8498 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8499 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8500 @end deffn
8501
8502 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8503 on the target device.
8504
8505 @example
8506 resume
8507
8508 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8509 rtt start
8510
8511 rtt server start 9090 0
8512 @end example
8513
8514 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8515 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8516 TCP/IP port 9090.
8517
8518
8519 @section Misc Commands
8520
8521 @cindex profiling
8522 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8523 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8524 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8525 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8526 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8527 limit the address range.
8528 @end deffn
8529
8530 @deffn {Command} {version}
8531 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8532 @end deffn
8533
8534 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8535 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8536 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8537 @end deffn
8538
8539 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8540 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8541 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8542 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8543
8544 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8545 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8546 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8547 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8548
8549 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8550 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8551 @cindex tracing
8552 @cindex ETM
8553 @cindex ETB
8554
8555 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8556 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8557 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8558
8559 @itemize
8560 @item
8561 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8562 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8563 supports such an interface.
8564 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8565 and trace port support.)
8566 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8567 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8568 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8569 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8570 in the board-specific configuration file.
8571 @item
8572 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8573 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8574 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8575 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8576 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8577 @end itemize
8578
8579 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8580
8581 @quotation Issues
8582 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8583 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8584
8585 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8586 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8587 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8588 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8589 dummy trace port driver}.
8590
8591 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8592 as well as tracing only during specific states
8593 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8594
8595 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8596 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8597 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8598 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8599 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8600
8601 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8602 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8603 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8604 this original style of JTAG access.
8605 @end quotation
8606
8607 @subsection ETM Configuration
8608 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8609
8610 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8611 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8612 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8613
8614 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8615 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8616 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8617 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8618 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8619 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8620 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8621 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8622 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8623
8624 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8625 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8626 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8627
8628 @quotation Warning
8629 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8630 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8631 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8632 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8633 @end quotation
8634
8635 @quotation Note
8636 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8637 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8638 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8639 what CPU activities are traced.
8640 @end quotation
8641 @end deffn
8642
8643 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8644 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8645 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8646 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8647 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8648 @end deffn
8649
8650 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8651 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8652 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8653 Did trace data overflow?
8654 Was it triggered?
8655 @end deffn
8656
8657 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8658 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8659 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8660 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8661 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8662
8663 @itemize
8664 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8665 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8666 The value is one of
8667 @option{none} (save nothing),
8668 @option{data} (save data),
8669 @option{address} (save addresses),
8670 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8671 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8672 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8673 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8674 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8675 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8676 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8677 trace stream without an image of the code.
8678 @end itemize
8679 @end deffn
8680
8681 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8682 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8683 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8684 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8685 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8686
8687 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8688 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8689 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8690 @end deffn
8691
8692 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8693
8694 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8695 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8696 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8697
8698 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8699 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8700 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8701 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8702 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8703 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8704 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8705
8706 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8707
8708 @itemize
8709 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8710 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8711 for instruction access within that function's body.
8712 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8713 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8714 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8715 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8716 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8717 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8718 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8719 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8720 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8721 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8722 @item @emph{... more}
8723 @end itemize
8724
8725 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8726 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8727
8728 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8729 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8730 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8731 @end deffn
8732
8733 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8734 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8735 @end deffn
8736
8737 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8738 Opens an image file.
8739 @end deffn
8740
8741 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8742 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8743 @end deffn
8744
8745 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8746 Starts trace data collection.
8747 @end deffn
8748
8749 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8750 Stops trace data collection.
8751 @end deffn
8752
8753 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8754 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8755
8756 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8757
8758 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8759 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8760 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8761 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8762 any trace data collection.}
8763 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8764 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8765 @end deffn
8766 @end deffn
8767
8768 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8769 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8770 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8771 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8772 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8773 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8774 @end deffn
8775 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8776 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8777 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8778 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8779 trace trigger becomes active.
8780
8781 @itemize
8782 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8783 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8784 afterwards.
8785 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8786 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8787 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8788 what caused that event to happen.
8789 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8790 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8791 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8792 how the event caused trouble.
8793 @end itemize
8794 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8795 @end deffn
8796
8797 @end deffn
8798
8799 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8800 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8801 @cindex CTI
8802
8803 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8804 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8805 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8806 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8807 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8808 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8809
8810 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8811 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8812 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8813 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8814 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8815 including additional configuration.
8816 @end deffn
8817
8818 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8819 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8820 @end deffn
8821
8822 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
8823 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8824 @end deffn
8825
8826 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8827 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8828 @end deffn
8829
8830 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8831 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8832 @end deffn
8833
8834 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8835 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8836 @end deffn
8837
8838 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8839 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8840 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8841 @end deffn
8842
8843 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8844 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8845 of the CTI.
8846 @end deffn
8847
8848 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
8849 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8850 useful in TCL scripting.
8851 @end deffn
8852
8853 @section Generic ARM
8854 @cindex ARM
8855
8856 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8857 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8858 commands that may be available.
8859
8860 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8861 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8862 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8863 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8864 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8865 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8866 @end deffn
8867
8868 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8869 @cindex disassemble
8870 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8871 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8872 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8873 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8874 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8875 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8876 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8877
8878 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8879 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8880 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8881 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8882 with a handful of exceptions.
8883 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8884 @end deffn
8885
8886 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8887 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8888 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8889 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8890 and using the MCR instruction.
8891 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8892 an ARM register.)
8893 @end deffn
8894
8895 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8896 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8897 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8898 and the MRC instruction.
8899 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8900 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8901 an ARM register.)
8902 @end deffn
8903
8904 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
8905 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8906 core mode if necessary.
8907 @end deffn
8908
8909 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8910 @cindex ARM semihosting
8911 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8912
8913 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8914 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8915 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8916 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8917 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8918 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8919 @end deffn
8920
8921 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8922 @cindex ARM semihosting
8923 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8924
8925 @example
8926 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8927 @end example
8928
8929 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8930 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8931 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8932 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8933 @end deffn
8934
8935 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8936 @cindex ARM semihosting
8937 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8938 status.
8939
8940 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8941 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8942 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8943 debugger.
8944 @end deffn
8945
8946 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8947 @cindex ARM semihosting
8948 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8949
8950 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8951 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8952 the value returned by the target.
8953
8954 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8955 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8956 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8957 encountering a break.
8958
8959 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8960 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8961 to the debugger.
8962 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8963 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8964 request or equivalent").
8965
8966 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8967 this option (default: disabled).
8968 @end deffn
8969
8970 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8971 @cindex ARMv4
8972 @cindex ARMv5
8973
8974 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8975 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8976 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8977 variant.
8978
8979 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8980 @cindex ARM7
8981 @cindex ARM9
8982
8983 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8984 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8985 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8986 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8987
8988 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8989 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8990 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8991 instead of breakpoints.
8992 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8993
8994 This should be
8995 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8996 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8997 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8998 @end deffn
8999
9000 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9001 @cindex DCC
9002 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9003 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9004 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9005
9006 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9007 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9008 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9009 @end deffn
9010
9011 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9012 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9013 that don't check completion of the operation.
9014 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9015
9016 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9017 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9018 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9019 @end deffn
9020
9021 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9022 @cindex ARM9
9023
9024 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9025 integer processors.
9026 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9027
9028 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9029 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9030 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9031 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9032
9033 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9034 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9035 @cindex vector_catch
9036 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9037 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9038 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9039 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9040 to those hardware vectors.
9041
9042 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9043 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9044 vector catch hardware to intercept
9045 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9046 @option{none} of them,
9047 or a list with one or more of the following:
9048 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9049 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9050 @end deffn
9051
9052 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9053 @cindex ARM920T
9054
9055 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9056 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9057 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9058 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9059 and ARM9 commands.
9060
9061 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9062 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9063 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9064 @end deffn
9065
9066 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9067 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9068 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9069 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9070 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9071 (Not all registers can be written.)
9072 @end deffn
9073
9074 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9075 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9076 @end deffn
9077
9078 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9079 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9080 @end deffn
9081
9082 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9083 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9084
9085 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9086 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9087 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9088 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9089 and ARM9 commands.
9090
9091 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9092 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9093
9094 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9095 Print information about the caches found.
9096 @end deffn
9097
9098 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9099 @cindex ARM966E
9100
9101 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9102 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9103 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9104 and ARM9 commands.
9105
9106 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9107 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9108 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9109 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9110 ARM966E-S TRM.
9111 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9112 as required for BIST support.
9113 @end deffn
9114
9115 @subsection XScale specific commands
9116 @cindex XScale
9117
9118 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9119
9120 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9121 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9122 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9123 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9124 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9125 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9126 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9127
9128 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9129 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9130 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9131 the mini-IC.
9132
9133 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9134 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9135 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9136 code layout in memory:
9137 @example
9138 _vectors:
9139 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9140 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9141 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9142 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9143 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9144 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9145 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9146 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9147 .org 0x100
9148 .long real_reset_vector
9149 .long real_ui_handler
9150 .long real_swi_handler
9151 .long real_pf_abort
9152 .long real_data_abort
9153 .long 0 /* unused */
9154 .long real_irq_handler
9155 .long real_fiq_handler
9156 @end example
9157
9158 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9159 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9160 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9161 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9162 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9163 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9164 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9165 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9166 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9167 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9168 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9169 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9170 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9171 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9172 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9173 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9174 software.
9175
9176 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9177 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9178 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9179 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9180
9181 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9182 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9183 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9184 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9185 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9186 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9187 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9188 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9189 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9190
9191 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9192 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9193
9194 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9195 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9196 @end deffn
9197
9198 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9199 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9200 @end deffn
9201
9202 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9203 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9204 @end deffn
9205
9206 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9207 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9208 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9209 @end deffn
9210
9211 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9212 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9213 @end deffn
9214
9215 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9216 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9217 @end deffn
9218
9219 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9220 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9221 @end deffn
9222
9223 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9224 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9225 @end deffn
9226
9227 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9228 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9229 @end deffn
9230
9231 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9232 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9233 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9234 and modifying how it is emptied.
9235 @end deffn
9236
9237 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9238 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9239 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9240 The image @var{type} may be one of
9241 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9242 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9243 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9244 @end deffn
9245
9246 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9247 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9248 @cindex vector_catch
9249 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9250 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9251
9252 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9253 @example
9254 0x01 Trap Reset
9255 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9256 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9257 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9258 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9259 0x20 reserved
9260 0x40 Trap IRQ
9261 0x80 Trap FIQ
9262 @end example
9263 @end deffn
9264
9265 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9266 @cindex vector_table
9267
9268 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9269 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9270 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9271 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9272 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9273
9274 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9275
9276 @end deffn
9277
9278 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9279 @cindex ARMv6
9280
9281 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9282 @cindex ARM11
9283
9284 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9285 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9286 which is enabled by default.
9287 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9288 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9289 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9290 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9291 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9292 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9293 @end deffn
9294
9295 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9296 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9297 which is enabled by default.
9298 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9299 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9300 @end deffn
9301
9302 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9303 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9304 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9305 they are disabled by default.
9306 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9307 @end deffn
9308
9309 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9310 @cindex vector_catch
9311 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9312 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9313 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9314
9315 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9316 for certain hardware events.
9317 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9318 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9319 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9320 @end deffn
9321
9322 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9323 @cindex ARMv7
9324 @cindex ARMv8
9325
9326 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9327 @cindex Cortex-A
9328
9329 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9330 display information about target caches
9331 @end deffn
9332
9333 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9334 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9335 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9336 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9337 Defaults to 'off'.
9338 @end deffn
9339
9340 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9341 Initialize core debug
9342 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9343 @end deffn
9344
9345 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9346 Display/set the current SMP mode
9347 @end deffn
9348
9349 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9350 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9351 @end deffn
9352
9353 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9354 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9355 @end deffn
9356
9357 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9358 configure l2x cache
9359 @end deffn
9360
9361 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9362 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9363 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9364 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9365 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9366 @end deffn
9367
9368 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9369 @cindex Cortex-R
9370
9371 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r dbginit}
9372 Initialize core debug
9373 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9374 @end deffn
9375
9376 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9377 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9378 @end deffn
9379
9380
9381 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9382 @cindex tracing
9383 @cindex SWO
9384 @cindex SWV
9385 @cindex TPIU
9386
9387 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9388 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9389 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9390 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9391
9392 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9393 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9394 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9395 which causes quite some confusion.
9396 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9397 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9398
9399 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9400 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9401 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9402
9403 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9404 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9405 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9406 @end deffn
9407
9408 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9409 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9410 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9411 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9412
9413 @itemize @bullet
9414 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9415 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9416 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9417 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9418
9419 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9420 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9421 @end itemize
9422 @end deffn
9423
9424 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9425 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9426 @end deffn
9427
9428 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9429 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9430 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9431 at any time after the initialization, too.
9432 @end deffn
9433
9434 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9435 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9436 individually queried, to return its current value.
9437 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9438 @end deffn
9439
9440 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9441 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9442 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9443 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9444
9445 @itemize @bullet
9446 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9447 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9448
9449 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9450 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9451
9452 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9453 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9454
9455 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9456 protocol used for trace data:
9457 @itemize @minus
9458 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9459 data bits (default);
9460 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9461 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9462 @end itemize
9463
9464 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9465 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9466 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9467 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9468 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9469 of the TPIU.
9470
9471 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9472 the destination of the trace data:
9473 @itemize @minus
9474 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9475 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9476 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9477 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9478 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9479 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9480 each connected client;
9481 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9482 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9483 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9484 @end itemize
9485
9486 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9487 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9488 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9489 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9490
9491 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9492 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9493 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9494 maximum supported rate automatically.
9495
9496 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9497 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9498 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9499
9500 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9501 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9502 default value is @var{0}.
9503 @end itemize
9504 @end deffn
9505
9506 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9507 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9508 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9509 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9510 data.
9511 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9512 after the @command{init}.
9513 @end deffn
9514
9515 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9516 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9517 @end deffn
9518
9519
9520
9521 Example usage:
9522 @enumerate
9523 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9524 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9525 enough to:
9526 @example
9527 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9528 ...
9529 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9530 ...
9531 @end example
9532 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9533 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9534 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9535 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9536 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9537 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9538 @example
9539 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9540 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9541 @end example
9542 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9543 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9544 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9545 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9546 @example
9547 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9548 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9549 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9550 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9551 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9552 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9553 @end example
9554 @end enumerate
9555
9556 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9557 @cindex tracing
9558 @cindex SWO
9559 @cindex SWV
9560 @cindex ITM
9561 @cindex ETM
9562
9563 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9564 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9565 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9566 @end deffn
9567
9568 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9569 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9570 @end deffn
9571
9572 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9573 @cindex Cortex-M
9574
9575 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9576 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9577
9578 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9579 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9580 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9581 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9582 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9583 the step command leaves with the core running.
9584
9585 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9586 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9587 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9588 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9589
9590 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9591 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9592 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9593 does.
9594
9595 Default is @option{auto}.
9596 @end deffn
9597
9598 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9599 @cindex vector_catch
9600 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9601 for certain hardware events.
9602
9603 Parameters request interception of
9604 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9605 @option{none} of them,
9606 or one or more of the following:
9607 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9608 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9609 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9610 @option{irq_err},
9611 @option{state_err},
9612 @option{chk_err}, or
9613 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9614 @option{reset}.
9615 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9616 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9617 are mapped to HardFault.
9618 UsageFault checks for
9619 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9620 must also be explicitly enabled.
9621
9622 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9623 @end deffn
9624
9625 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9626 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9627 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9628
9629 @itemize @minus
9630 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9631 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9632 @end itemize
9633
9634 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9635 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9636 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9637 to manually reset the peripherals.
9638 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9639
9640 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9641 instead.
9642 @end deffn
9643
9644 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9645 @cindex ARMv8-A
9646 @cindex aarch64
9647
9648 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9649 Display information about target caches
9650 @end deffn
9651
9652 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9653 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9654 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9655 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9656 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9657 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9658 @end deffn
9659
9660 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9661 @cindex disassemble
9662 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9663 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9664 @end deffn
9665
9666 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9667 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9668 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9669 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9670 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9671 @end deffn
9672
9673 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9674 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9675 @option{on}.
9676 @end deffn
9677
9678 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9679 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9680 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9681 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9682 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9683 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9684 @end deffn
9685
9686 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9687
9688 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9689 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9690
9691 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9692
9693 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9694 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9695 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9696 @end deffn
9697
9698 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9699 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9700 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9701 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9702 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9703 @end deffn
9704
9705 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9706
9707 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9708 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9709 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9710 @end deffn
9711
9712 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9713
9714 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9715 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9716 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9717 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9718 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9719 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9720 can be collected.
9721
9722 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9723 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9724 tooling.
9725
9726 @quotation Issues
9727 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9728 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9729 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9730 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9731
9732 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9733 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9734 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9735 software operation on the CPU.
9736 @end quotation
9737
9738 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9739 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9740 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9741 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9742 @end deffn
9743
9744 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9745 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9746 @end deffn
9747
9748 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9749 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9750 control is disabled.
9751 @end deffn
9752
9753 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9754 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9755 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9756 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9757
9758 Supported trace formats:
9759 @itemize
9760 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9761 timing to be determined.
9762 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9763 addresses.
9764 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9765 @end itemize
9766 @end deffn
9767
9768 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9769 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9770 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9771 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9772
9773 Supported conditions:
9774 @itemize
9775 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9776 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9777 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9778 instruction matches start data and mask.
9779 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9780 instruction matches start data and mask.
9781 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9782 data and mask.
9783 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9784 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9785 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9786 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9787 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9788 @end itemize
9789 @end deffn
9790
9791 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9792 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9793 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9794 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9795
9796 Supported conditions:
9797 @itemize
9798 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9799 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9800 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9801 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9802 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9803 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9804 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9805 data and mask.
9806 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9807 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9808 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9809 @end itemize
9810 @end deffn
9811
9812 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9813 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9814
9815 Supported triggers:
9816 @itemize
9817 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9818 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9819 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9820 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9821 collection.
9822 @end itemize
9823 @end deffn
9824
9825 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9826
9827 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
9828 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9829 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9830 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9831 @end deffn
9832
9833 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
9834 Display trace configuration.
9835 @end deffn
9836
9837 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
9838 Display trace collection status.
9839 @end deffn
9840
9841 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
9842 Start manual trace collection.
9843 @end deffn
9844
9845 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
9846 Stop manual trace collection.
9847 @end deffn
9848
9849 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9850 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9851 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9852 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9853 @option{size} options using DMA.
9854 @end deffn
9855
9856 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9857 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9858 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9859 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9860 @option{size} options using DMA.
9861 @end deffn
9862
9863 @section Intel Architecture
9864
9865 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9866 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9867 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9868 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9869 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9870 @itemize
9871 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9872 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9873 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9874 @end itemize
9875
9876 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9877 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9878 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9879
9880 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
9881 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9882 @end deffn
9883
9884 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
9885 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9886 @end deffn
9887
9888 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
9889 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9890 @end deffn
9891
9892 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
9893 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9894 @end deffn
9895
9896 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
9897 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9898 @end deffn
9899
9900 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
9901 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9902 @end deffn
9903
9904 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9905
9906 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9907 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9908
9909 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9910 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9911 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9912 @end deffn
9913 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9914 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9915
9916 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9917
9918 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9919 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9920 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9921 @end deffn
9922
9923 @subsection Registers commands
9924 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9925 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9926 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9927
9928 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9929
9930 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9931 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9932 and "timer" groups.
9933
9934 @emph{example:}
9935 @example
9936 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9937 @end example
9938
9939
9940 @end deffn
9941 @deffn {Command} {readgroup} (@option{group})
9942 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9943
9944 @emph{group} can be "system",
9945 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9946 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9947 @end deffn
9948
9949 @section RISC-V Architecture
9950
9951 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9952 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9953 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9954 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9955 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9956 implement version 0.11.
9957
9958 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9959
9960 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9961 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9962 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9963
9964 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9965
9966 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9967 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9968 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9969
9970 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9971 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9972 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9973 CSRs.
9974 @end deffn
9975
9976 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9977 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9978 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9979 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9980 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9981 This command must be executed before `init`.
9982 @end deffn
9983
9984 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9985 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9986 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9987 @end deffn
9988
9989 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9990 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9991 deasserted.
9992 @end deffn
9993
9994 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9995 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9996 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9997 @end deffn
9998
9999 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10000 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10001 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10002 @end deffn
10003
10004 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10005 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10006 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10007 on physical memory.
10008 @end deffn
10009
10010 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10011 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10012 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10013 performed on physical memory.
10014 @end deffn
10015
10016 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10017 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10018 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10019 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10020 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10021 race condition problem in your code.
10022
10023 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10024 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10025 @end deffn
10026
10027 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10028 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10029 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10030 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10031 values.
10032
10033 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10034 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10035 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10036 @end deffn
10037
10038 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10039 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10040 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10041 @end deffn
10042
10043 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10044 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10045 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10046 @end deffn
10047
10048 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10049 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10050 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10051 @end deffn
10052
10053 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10054 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10055 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10056 @end deffn
10057
10058 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10059
10060 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10061 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10062 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10063 @example
10064 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10065 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10066 @end example
10067
10068 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10069 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10070 @end deffn
10071
10072 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10073 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10074 @end deffn
10075
10076 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10077
10078 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10079 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10080
10081 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10082 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10083 @end deffn
10084
10085 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10086 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10087 @end deffn
10088
10089 @section ARC Architecture
10090 @cindex ARC
10091
10092 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10093 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10094 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10095 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10096 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10097 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10098 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10099 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10100 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10101 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10102 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10103 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10104 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10105 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10106 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10107
10108
10109 @subsection General ARC commands
10110
10111 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10112
10113 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10114 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10115 arguments:
10116
10117 @itemize @bullet
10118
10119 @item @code{-name} name
10120 @*Name of a register.
10121
10122 @item @code{-num} number
10123 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10124
10125 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10126 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10127
10128 @end itemize
10129
10130 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10131
10132 @itemize @bullet
10133
10134 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10135 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10136 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10137 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10138 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10139 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10140
10141 @item @code{-core}
10142 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10143 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10144 spaces.
10145
10146 @item @code{-bcr}
10147 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10148 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10149 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10150 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10151 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10152
10153 @item @code{-type} type_name
10154 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10155 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10156
10157 @item @code{-g}
10158 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10159 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10160 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10161 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10162 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10163
10164 @end itemize
10165
10166 @end deffn
10167
10168 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10169 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10170 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10171 @end deffn
10172
10173 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10174 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10175 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10176 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10177 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10178 startbit endbit}.
10179 @end deffn
10180
10181 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10182 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10183 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
10184 @end deffn
10185
10186 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10187 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10188 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10189 @end deffn
10190
10191 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10192
10193 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10194 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10195 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10196 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10197
10198 @end deffn
10199
10200 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10201 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10202 registers.
10203 @end deffn
10204
10205 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10206 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10207 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10208 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10209
10210 @end deffn
10211
10212 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10213 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10214 registers.
10215 @end deffn
10216
10217 @section STM8 Architecture
10218 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10219 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10220
10221 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10222 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10223
10224 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10225 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10226 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10227 @cindex tracing
10228 @cindex libdcc
10229 @cindex DCC
10230 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10231 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10232 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10233 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10234
10235 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10236 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10237 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10238 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10239 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10240 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10241
10242 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10243 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10244 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10245 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10246 The target being debugged may
10247 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10248 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10249 each supported by a command:
10250
10251 @itemize
10252 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10253 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10254 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10255 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10256
10257 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10258 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10259 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10260
10261 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10262 and then displayed at any time.
10263 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10264
10265 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10266 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10267 @end itemize
10268
10269 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10270 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10271 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10272 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10273 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10274 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10275 does the same thing.
10276
10277 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10278 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10279 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10280 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10281 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10282
10283 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10284 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10285 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10286 @end deffn
10287
10288 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10289 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10290 in the order they triggered.
10291 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10292 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10293 history records.
10294 @end deffn
10295
10296 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10297 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10298 they have been triggered.
10299 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10300 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10301 and associates it with that identifier.
10302
10303 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10304 are not related except by this command.
10305 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10306 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10307 @end deffn
10308
10309
10310 @node JTAG Commands
10311 @chapter JTAG Commands
10312 @cindex JTAG Commands
10313 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10314 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10315 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10316 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10317 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10318
10319 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10320 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10321
10322 @itemize @bullet
10323 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10324 devices such as a CPUs.
10325 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10326 standard state machine (in parallel)
10327 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10328 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10329 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10330 while the reading previous ones.
10331 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10332 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10333 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10334 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10335 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10336 registers.
10337 @end itemize
10338
10339 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10340
10341 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10342 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10343 the order of TAP state transitions.
10344 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10345 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10346 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10347 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10348 these commands are not available.
10349
10350 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10351 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10352 that specify the entire register.
10353 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10354 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10355 The return value holds the original value of each
10356 of those fields.
10357
10358 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10359 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10360 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10361 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10362 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10363
10364 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10365 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10366
10367 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10368 in that state.
10369 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10370 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10371 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10372
10373 @quotation Warning
10374 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10375 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10376 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10377 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10378 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10379 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10380 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10381 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10382 @end quotation
10383 @end deffn
10384
10385 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10386 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10387 This may be used for performance tuning.
10388
10389 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10390 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10391 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10392 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10393 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10394 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10395 @end deffn
10396
10397 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10398 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10399 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10400 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10401 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10402 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10403
10404 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10405 in that state.
10406 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10407 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10408 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10409
10410 @quotation Note
10411 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10412 register values, unlike data register values.
10413 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10414 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10415 @end quotation
10416 @end deffn
10417
10418 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10419 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10420 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10421 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10422 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10423 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10424 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10425 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10426 The final state must also be stable.
10427 @end deffn
10428
10429 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10430 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10431 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10432 Instructions often need some time
10433 to execute before they take effect.
10434 @end deffn
10435
10436 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10437 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10438
10439 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10440 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10441 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10442 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10443 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10444 @end deffn
10445
10446 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10447 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10448 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10449 must also be enabled.
10450 Default is enabled.
10451 @end deffn
10452
10453 @section TAP state names
10454 @cindex TAP state names
10455
10456 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10457 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10458 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10459 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10460
10461 @itemize @bullet
10462 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10463 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10464 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10465 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10466 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10467 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10468 through the data register
10469 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10470 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10471 for update or more shifting
10472 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10473 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10474 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10475 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10476 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10477 through the instruction register
10478 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10479 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10480 for update or more shifting
10481 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10482 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10483 @end itemize
10484
10485 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10486 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10487 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10488 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10489
10490 @itemize @bullet
10491 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10492 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10493 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10494 may not be as expected.
10495 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10496 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10497 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10498 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10499 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10500 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10501 @end itemize
10502
10503 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10504 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10505
10506 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10507 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10508 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10509 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10510
10511 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10512 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10513 @cindex SVF
10514
10515 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10516 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10517 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10518 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10519
10520 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10521 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10522 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10523 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10524
10525 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10526 affect their semantics.
10527
10528 Command options:
10529 @itemize @minus
10530 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10531 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10532 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10533 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10534 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10535 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10536 on the real interface;
10537 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10538 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10539 errors.
10540 @end itemize
10541 @end deffn
10542
10543 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10544 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10545 @cindex XSVF
10546
10547 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10548 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10549 Xilinx devices.
10550 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10551 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10552
10553 @quotation Important
10554 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10555 @end quotation
10556
10557 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10558 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10559 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10560 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10561 that TAP.
10562 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10563 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10564 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10565 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10566 @end deffn
10567
10568 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10569 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10570 after building the software.
10571 You may find them useful:
10572
10573 @itemize
10574 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10575 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10576 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10577 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10578 @end itemize
10579
10580 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10581 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10582 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10583 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10584 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10585 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10586 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10587
10588
10589 @node Utility Commands
10590 @chapter Utility Commands
10591 @cindex Utility Commands
10592
10593 @section RAM testing
10594 @cindex RAM testing
10595
10596 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10597 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10598 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10599 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10600 hardware problems.
10601
10602 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10603 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10604 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10605 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10606
10607 Load the memory testing functions with
10608
10609 @example
10610 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10611 @end example
10612
10613 to get access to the following facilities:
10614
10615 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10616 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10617 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10618 @end deffn
10619
10620 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10621 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10622 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10623 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10624 @end deffn
10625
10626 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10627 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10628 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10629 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10630 @end deffn
10631
10632 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10633 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10634 @end deffn
10635
10636 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10637 @cindex Firmware recovery
10638
10639 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10640 devices recovery with JTAG.
10641
10642 For quickstart instructions run:
10643 @example
10644 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10645 @end example
10646
10647 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10648 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10649 @cindex GDB
10650 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10651 to debug remote targets.
10652 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10653
10654 @itemize
10655 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10656 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10657 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10658 as shown in this chapter.
10659 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10660 that also will probably need to be configured.
10661 @end itemize
10662
10663 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10664 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10665 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10666 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10667 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10668 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10669
10670 @section Connecting to GDB
10671 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10672 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10673 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10674 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10675 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10676
10677 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10678
10679 @enumerate
10680 @item
10681 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10682 @example
10683 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10684 @end example
10685 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10686
10687 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10688 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10689 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10690
10691 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10692 remote command above that becomes:
10693 @example
10694 tar ext :3333
10695 @end example
10696
10697 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10698 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10699 available through the command:
10700 @example
10701 target remote localhost:3333
10702 @end example
10703
10704 @item
10705 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10706 @example
10707 target extended-remote | \
10708 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10709 @end example
10710 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10711 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10712 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10713 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10714 @end enumerate
10715
10716 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10717 GDB command line.
10718
10719 @section Sample GDB session startup
10720
10721 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10722 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10723 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10724 small ARM program.
10725 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10726 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10727
10728 @example
10729 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10730 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10731 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10732 ...
10733 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10734 ...
10735 (gdb) load
10736 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10737 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10738 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10739 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10740 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10741 (gdb) continue
10742 Continuing.
10743 ...
10744 @end example
10745
10746 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10747 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10748 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10749 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10750
10751 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10752
10753 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10754 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10755 packet size and the device's memory map.
10756 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10757 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10758 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10759
10760 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10761 You may need to set those up by hand.
10762 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10763 something like:
10764
10765 @example
10766 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10767 @end example
10768
10769 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10770
10771 @example
10772 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10773 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10774 @end example
10775
10776 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10777 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10778 do not have such restrictions.
10779
10780 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10781 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10782 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10783 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10784
10785 @section Programming using GDB
10786 @cindex Programming using GDB
10787 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10788
10789 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10790 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10791 @example
10792 gdb_memory_map disable
10793 @end example
10794 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10795 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10796 working area.
10797
10798 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10799 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10800 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10801 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10802
10803 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10804 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10805
10806 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10807 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10808 @example
10809 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10810 @end example
10811
10812 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10813 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10814
10815 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10816 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10817 will be used.
10818
10819 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10820 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10821 @example
10822 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10823 @end example
10824 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10825
10826 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10827 can be used.
10828
10829 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10830 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10831 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10832
10833 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10834 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10835 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10836
10837 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10838 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10839 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10840 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10841 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10842 without any intrusion of the target process.
10843
10844 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10845 Place following command after target configuration:
10846 @example
10847 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10848 @end example
10849
10850 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10851 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10852 @example
10853 gdb_memory_map disable
10854 @end example
10855
10856 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10857 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10858 @example
10859 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10860 @end example
10861
10862 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10863 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10864
10865 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10866 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10867 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10868 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10869
10870 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10871 previously shown variables.
10872
10873 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
10874 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
10875 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
10876 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
10877 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
10878
10879 @section RTOS Support
10880 @cindex RTOS Support
10881 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10882
10883 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10884 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10885
10886 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10887 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10888 GDB commands.
10889
10890 @* An example setup is below:
10891
10892 @example
10893 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10894 @end example
10895
10896 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10897
10898 Currently supported rtos's include:
10899 @itemize @bullet
10900 @item @option{eCos}
10901 @item @option{ThreadX}
10902 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10903 @item @option{linux}
10904 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10905 @item @option{embKernel}
10906 @item @option{mqx}
10907 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10908 @item @option{nuttx}
10909 @item @option{RIOT}
10910 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10911 @end itemize
10912
10913 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10914 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10915
10916 @table @code
10917 @item eCos symbols
10918 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10919 @item ThreadX symbols
10920 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10921 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10922 @raggedright
10923 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10924 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10925 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10926 @end raggedright
10927 @item linux symbols
10928 init_task.
10929 @item ChibiOS symbols
10930 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10931 @item embKernel symbols
10932 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10933 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10934 @item mqx symbols
10935 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10936 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10937 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
10938 @item nuttx symbols
10939 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
10940 @item RIOT symbols
10941 @raggedright
10942 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
10943 _tcb_name_offset.
10944 @end raggedright
10945 @end table
10946
10947 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10948 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10949
10950 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10951 along with the project:
10952
10953 @table @code
10954 @item FreeRTOS
10955 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10956 @item uC/OS-III
10957 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10958 @end table
10959
10960 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10961 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10962 @cindex SMP
10963 @cindex RTOS
10964 @cindex hwthread
10965 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10966 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10967 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10968 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10969 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10970 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10971 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10972 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10973 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10974
10975 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10976 @quotation Note
10977 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10978 @end quotation
10979
10980 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10981 @itemize @bullet
10982 @item j - smp status request
10983 @item J - smp set request
10984 @end itemize
10985
10986 OpenOCD implements :
10987 @itemize @bullet
10988 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10989 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10990 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10991 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10992 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10993 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10994 @end itemize
10995
10996 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10997 @itemize @bullet
10998 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10999 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11000 @example
11001 set $_core 1
11002 #Jc01 packet is sent
11003 print $_core
11004 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11005 @end example
11006
11007 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11008 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11009
11010 @example
11011 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11012 define toggle0
11013 maint packet Jc0
11014 continue
11015 main packet Jc-1
11016 end
11017 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11018 define toggle1
11019 maint packet Jc1
11020 continue
11021 main packet Jc-1
11022 end
11023 @end example
11024 @end itemize
11025
11026 @node Tcl Scripting API
11027 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11028 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11029 @cindex Tcl scripts
11030 @section API rules
11031
11032 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11033 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11034 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11035
11036 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11037 pair list and lists.
11038
11039 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11040 list.
11041
11042 @example
11043 > set foo(me) Duane
11044 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11045 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11046 > set foo(duck) Donald
11047 @end example
11048
11049 If one does this:
11050
11051 @example
11052 > set foo
11053 @end example
11054
11055 The result is:
11056
11057 @example
11058 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11059 @end example
11060
11061 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11062
11063 @verbatim
11064 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11065 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11066 }
11067 @end verbatim
11068
11069 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11070 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11071
11072 @section Internal low-level Commands
11073
11074 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
11075 invoke directly.
11076
11077 @itemize @bullet
11078 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11079
11080 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11081 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11082
11083 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11084 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11085
11086 Return information about the flash banks
11087
11088 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11089
11090 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11091 its execution. Example:
11092
11093 @example
11094 > capture "reset init"
11095 @end example
11096
11097 @end itemize
11098
11099 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11100 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11101 called "flash_banks".
11102
11103 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
11104
11105 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
11106 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
11107 holds one of the following values:
11108
11109 @itemize @bullet
11110 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
11111 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
11112 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
11113 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
11114 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
11115 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
11116 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
11117 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
11118 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
11119 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
11120 @end itemize
11121
11122 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
11123
11124 @quotation Note
11125 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
11126 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
11127 @code{jim_platform} (because it
11128 is jim, not real tcl).
11129 @end quotation
11130
11131 @section Tcl RPC server
11132 @cindex RPC
11133
11134 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11135 commands and receive the results.
11136
11137 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11138 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11139 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11140 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11141 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11142
11143 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11144 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11145 @command{capture} command.
11146
11147 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11148
11149 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11150 @cindex RPC Notifications
11151
11152 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11153 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11154
11155 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11156 in the following format.
11157
11158 @verbatim
11159 type target_event event [event-name]
11160 type target_state state [state-name]
11161 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11162 @end verbatim
11163
11164 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11165 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11166 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11167 Defaults to off.
11168
11169 @end deffn
11170
11171 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11172 @cindex RPC trace output
11173
11174 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11175 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11176
11177 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11178
11179 @verbatim
11180 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11181 @end verbatim
11182
11183 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11184 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11185 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11186 Defaults to off.
11187
11188 See an example application here:
11189 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11190
11191 @end deffn
11192
11193 @node FAQ
11194 @chapter FAQ
11195 @cindex faq
11196 @enumerate
11197 @anchor{faqrtck}
11198 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11199 @cindex RTCK
11200 @cindex adaptive clocking
11201 @*
11202
11203 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11204 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11205 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11206 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11207
11208 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11209 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11210 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11211 @enumerate
11212 @item
11213 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11214 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11215 @item
11216 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11217 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11218 @end enumerate
11219
11220 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11221 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11222 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11223 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11224 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11225 power).
11226
11227 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11228 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11229 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11230 ARM926 scenario).
11231 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11232 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11233 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11234
11235 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11236 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11237 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11238 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11239
11240 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11241
11242 In order to make use of this,
11243 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11244 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11245
11246 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11247 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11248 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11249 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11250 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11251
11252 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11253 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11254 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11255 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11256
11257 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11258 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11259 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11260 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11261 with a CPLD.
11262 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11263 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11264 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11265 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11266 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11267 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11268
11269 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11270
11271 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11272
11273 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11274 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11275 depending on the chips on your board.
11276 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11277 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11278 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11279
11280 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11281 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11282 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11283
11284 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11285 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11286 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11287 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11288
11289 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11290 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11291 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11292 this way.
11293
11294 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11295 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11296 clock rate.
11297 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11298 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11299 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11300
11301 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11302
11303 @example
11304 # Example: 1.234MHz
11305 adapter speed 1234
11306 @end example
11307
11308
11309 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11310
11311 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11312 around Windows filenames.
11313
11314 @example
11315 > echo \a
11316
11317 > echo @{\a@}
11318 \a
11319 > echo "\a"
11320
11321 >
11322 @end example
11323
11324
11325 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11326
11327 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11328 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11329 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11330
11331 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11332 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11333 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11334
11335 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11336 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11337 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11338
11339 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11340
11341 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11342 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11343 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11344 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11345
11346 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11347 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11348 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11349
11350 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11351 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11352
11353 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11354 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11355 memory read caused data abort".
11356
11357 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11358 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11359 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11360 be done, feel free to add this here.
11361
11362 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11363 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11364 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11365 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11366 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11367 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11368 gracefully stops.
11369
11370 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11371 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11372 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11373
11374 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11375 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11376 bytes. Painful...
11377
11378
11379 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11380 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11381
11382 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11383 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11384 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11385 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11386 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11387 reset, everything else should work fine.
11388
11389 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11390 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11391 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11392 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11393
11394 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11395 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11396 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11397 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11398
11399 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11400
11401 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11402 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11403 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11404
11405 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11406 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11407
11408 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11409 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11410 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11411 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11412 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11413 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11414 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11415 clock frequency?
11416
11417 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11418 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11419 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11420 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11421 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11422
11423 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11424
11425 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11426 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11427 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11428 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11429 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11430 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11431 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11432
11433 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11434
11435 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11436 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11437 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11438 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11439
11440 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11441 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11442 particular order?
11443
11444 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11445 the same order used by the hardware.
11446
11447 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11448 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11449 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11450 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11451 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11452 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11453
11454 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11455 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11456 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11457 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11458
11459 @itemize @bullet
11460 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11461 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11462 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11463 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11464 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11465 @end itemize
11466
11467 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11468
11469 @itemize @bullet
11470 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11471 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11472 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11473 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11474 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11475 @end itemize
11476
11477
11478 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11479 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11480 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11481
11482 TODO.
11483
11484 @end enumerate
11485
11486 @node Tcl Crash Course
11487 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11488 @cindex Tcl
11489
11490 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11491 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11492 how the Tcl scripts work.
11493
11494 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11495 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11496 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11497 OpenOCD.
11498
11499 @section Tcl Rule #1
11500 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11501 @enumerate
11502 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11503 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11504 @end enumerate
11505
11506 The Tcl equal is this:
11507
11508 @enumerate
11509 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11510 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11511 @end enumerate
11512
11513 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11514 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11515
11516 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11517 There is a second pair of rules.
11518 @enumerate
11519 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11520 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11521 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11522 in Tcl.
11523 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11524 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11525 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11526 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11527 @end enumerate
11528
11529 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11530 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11531 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11532 Everything is a string}
11533
11534 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11535 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11536 difference is subtle.
11537 @enumerate
11538 @item Parse Time
11539 @item Evaluation Time
11540 @end enumerate
11541
11542 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11543 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11544 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11545
11546 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11547 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11548 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11549 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11550
11551 @itemize @bullet
11552 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11553 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11554 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11555 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11556 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11557 @example
11558 # bash example
11559 X=`date`
11560 echo "The Date is: $X"
11561 # Tcl example
11562 set X [date]
11563 puts "The Date is: $X"
11564 @end example
11565 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11566 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11567 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11568 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11569 is a string}
11570 @example
11571 set x "Dinner"
11572 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11573 @end example
11574 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11575 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11576 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11577 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11578 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11579 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11580 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11581 @end itemize
11582
11583 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11584
11585 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11586
11587 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11588
11589 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11590 the normal way.
11591
11592 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11593 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11594 line is immediately executed.
11595
11596 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11597 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11598
11599 @subsection Command Execution
11600
11601 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11602 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11603 control flow operators.
11604
11605 Commands are executed like this:
11606
11607 @enumerate
11608 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11609 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11610 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11611 @end enumerate
11612
11613 It sort of works like this:
11614 @example
11615 for(;;)@{
11616 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11617
11618 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11619
11620 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11621 @}
11622 @end example
11623
11624 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11625 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11626 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11627 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11628 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11629 ``LookupCommand()''
11630
11631 @subsection The FOR command
11632
11633 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11634 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11635 command just like any other command.
11636
11637 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11638 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11639 are:
11640
11641 @enumerate 0
11642 @item The ascii text 'for'
11643 @item The start text
11644 @item The test expression
11645 @item The next text
11646 @item The body text
11647 @end enumerate
11648
11649 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11650 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11651 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11652 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11653
11654 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11655 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11656
11657 @example
11658 int
11659 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11660 int *argc,
11661 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11662 @end example
11663
11664 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11665 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11666 still operates in the same basic way.
11667
11668 @subsection FOR command implementation
11669
11670 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11671 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11672
11673 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11674
11675 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11676
11677 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11678 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11679 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11680
11681 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11682 expression and returns a value.
11683
11684 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11685 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11686 @example
11687 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11688
11689 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11690
11691 int
11692 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11693 int argc,
11694 char **argv )
11695 @{
11696 if( argc != 5 )@{
11697 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11698 return ERROR;
11699 @}
11700
11701 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11702
11703 // Execute the start statement.
11704 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11705
11706 // Top of loop test
11707 for(;;)@{
11708 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11709 if( i == 0 )
11710 break;
11711
11712 // Execute the body
11713 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11714
11715 // Execute the LOOP part
11716 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11717 @}
11718
11719 // Return no error
11720 SetResult( interp, "" );
11721 return SUCCESS;
11722 @}
11723 @end example
11724
11725 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11726 in the same basic way.
11727
11728 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11729
11730 @subsection source and find commands
11731 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11732 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11733 @*Remember the parsing rules
11734 @enumerate
11735 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11736 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11737 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11738 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11739 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11740 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11741 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11742 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11743 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11744 @end enumerate
11745 @subsection format command
11746 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11747 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11748 @b{sprintf()}.
11749 @b{Example}
11750 @example
11751 set x 6
11752 set y 7
11753 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11754 @end example
11755 @enumerate
11756 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11757 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11758 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11759 @* Refer to Rule #1
11760 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11761 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11762 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11763 @end enumerate
11764 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11765 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11766 @example
11767 #1 Good
11768 proc someproc @{@} @{
11769 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11770 @}
11771 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11772 #2 Good - no variables
11773 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11774 #3 Good Curly Braces
11775 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11776 puts "Time: [date]"
11777 @}
11778 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11779 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11780 @end example
11781 @enumerate
11782 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11783 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11784 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11785 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11786 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11787 command.
11788 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11789 @*There are 4 examples:
11790 @enumerate
11791 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11792 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11793 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11794 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11795 @end enumerate
11796
11797 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11798 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11799 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11800
11801 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11802 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11803 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11804 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11805 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11806 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11807 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11808 @end enumerate
11809 @subsection Global Variables
11810 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11811 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11812 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11813 @example
11814 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11815 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11816 global x #Global variable X
11817 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11818 @}
11819 @end example
11820 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11821 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11822 @example
11823 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11824 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11825 # Create var name
11826 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11827 # Make it a global
11828 global $vn
11829 # Set it.
11830 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11831 @}
11832 @end example
11833 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11834 @example
11835 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11836 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11837 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11838 @}
11839 @end example
11840
11841 @node License
11842 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
11843 @include fdl.texi
11844
11845 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11846 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11847 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11848 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11849 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11850 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11851
11852 @printindex cp
11853
11854 @node Command and Driver Index
11855 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11856 @printindex fn
11857
11858 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)